include/elf/
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elfxx-mips.c
1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF
2 Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
6 <ian@cygnus.com>.
7 N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
8 <mark@codesourcery.com>
9 Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
10 Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
11
12 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
13
14 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
15 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
16 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
17 (at your option) any later version.
18
19 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
20 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
21 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
22 GNU General Public License for more details.
23
24 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
25 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
26 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
27 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
28
29
30 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's. */
31
32 #include "sysdep.h"
33 #include "bfd.h"
34 #include "libbfd.h"
35 #include "libiberty.h"
36 #include "elf-bfd.h"
37 #include "elfxx-mips.h"
38 #include "elf/mips.h"
39 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
40
41 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines. */
42 #include "coff/sym.h"
43 #include "coff/symconst.h"
44 #include "coff/ecoff.h"
45 #include "coff/mips.h"
46
47 #include "hashtab.h"
48
49 /* This structure is used to hold information about one GOT entry.
50 There are three types of entry:
51
52 (1) absolute addresses
53 (abfd == NULL)
54 (2) SYMBOL + OFFSET addresses, where SYMBOL is local to an input bfd
55 (abfd != NULL, symndx >= 0)
56 (3) global and forced-local symbols
57 (abfd != NULL, symndx == -1)
58
59 Type (3) entries are treated differently for different types of GOT.
60 In the "master" GOT -- i.e. the one that describes every GOT
61 reference needed in the link -- the mips_got_entry is keyed on both
62 the symbol and the input bfd that references it. If it turns out
63 that we need multiple GOTs, we can then use this information to
64 create separate GOTs for each input bfd.
65
66 However, we want each of these separate GOTs to have at most one
67 entry for a given symbol, so their type (3) entries are keyed only
68 on the symbol. The input bfd given by the "abfd" field is somewhat
69 arbitrary in this case.
70
71 This means that when there are multiple GOTs, each GOT has a unique
72 mips_got_entry for every symbol within it. We can therefore use the
73 mips_got_entry fields (tls_type and gotidx) to track the symbol's
74 GOT index.
75
76 However, if it turns out that we need only a single GOT, we continue
77 to use the master GOT to describe it. There may therefore be several
78 mips_got_entries for the same symbol, each with a different input bfd.
79 We want to make sure that each symbol gets a unique GOT entry, so when
80 there's a single GOT, we use the symbol's hash entry, not the
81 mips_got_entry fields, to track a symbol's GOT index. */
82 struct mips_got_entry
83 {
84 /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */
85 bfd *abfd;
86 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
87 we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise. */
88 long symndx;
89 union
90 {
91 /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got. */
92 bfd_vma address;
93 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
94 that should be added to the symbol value. */
95 bfd_vma addend;
96 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
97 corresponding to a global symbol in the got (or, local, if
98 h->forced_local). */
99 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
100 } d;
101
102 /* The TLS types included in this GOT entry (specifically, GD and
103 IE). The GD and IE flags can be added as we encounter new
104 relocations. LDM can also be set; it will always be alone, not
105 combined with any GD or IE flags. An LDM GOT entry will be
106 a local symbol entry with r_symndx == 0. */
107 unsigned char tls_type;
108
109 /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
110 corresponding to this symbol+addend. If it's a global symbol
111 whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1. */
112 long gotidx;
113 };
114
115 /* This structure describes a range of addends: [MIN_ADDEND, MAX_ADDEND].
116 The structures form a non-overlapping list that is sorted by increasing
117 MIN_ADDEND. */
118 struct mips_got_page_range
119 {
120 struct mips_got_page_range *next;
121 bfd_signed_vma min_addend;
122 bfd_signed_vma max_addend;
123 };
124
125 /* This structure describes the range of addends that are applied to page
126 relocations against a given symbol. */
127 struct mips_got_page_entry
128 {
129 /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */
130 bfd *abfd;
131 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info. */
132 long symndx;
133 /* The ranges for this page entry. */
134 struct mips_got_page_range *ranges;
135 /* The maximum number of page entries needed for RANGES. */
136 bfd_vma num_pages;
137 };
138
139 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking. */
140
141 struct mips_got_info
142 {
143 /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
144 symbol table. */
145 struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
146 /* The number of global .got entries. */
147 unsigned int global_gotno;
148 /* The number of .got slots used for TLS. */
149 unsigned int tls_gotno;
150 /* The first unused TLS .got entry. Used only during
151 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
152 unsigned int tls_assigned_gotno;
153 /* The number of local .got entries, eventually including page entries. */
154 unsigned int local_gotno;
155 /* The maximum number of page entries needed. */
156 unsigned int page_gotno;
157 /* The number of local .got entries we have used. */
158 unsigned int assigned_gotno;
159 /* A hash table holding members of the got. */
160 struct htab *got_entries;
161 /* A hash table of mips_got_page_entry structures. */
162 struct htab *got_page_entries;
163 /* A hash table mapping input bfds to other mips_got_info. NULL
164 unless multi-got was necessary. */
165 struct htab *bfd2got;
166 /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
167 of the time, it points to the previous got). */
168 struct mips_got_info *next;
169 /* This is the GOT index of the TLS LDM entry for the GOT, MINUS_ONE
170 for none, or MINUS_TWO for not yet assigned. This is needed
171 because a single-GOT link may have multiple hash table entries
172 for the LDM. It does not get initialized in multi-GOT mode. */
173 bfd_vma tls_ldm_offset;
174 };
175
176 /* Map an input bfd to a got in a multi-got link. */
177
178 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash {
179 bfd *bfd;
180 struct mips_got_info *g;
181 };
182
183 /* Structure passed when traversing the bfd2got hash table, used to
184 create and merge bfd's gots. */
185
186 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
187 {
188 /* A hashtable that maps bfds to gots. */
189 htab_t bfd2got;
190 /* The output bfd. */
191 bfd *obfd;
192 /* The link information. */
193 struct bfd_link_info *info;
194 /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
195 the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
196 DT_MIPS_GOTSYM. */
197 struct mips_got_info *primary;
198 /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
199 gots. */
200 struct mips_got_info *current;
201 /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
202 16-bit offset. */
203 unsigned int max_count;
204 /* The maximum number of page entries needed by each got. */
205 unsigned int max_pages;
206 /* The total number of global entries which will live in the
207 primary got and be automatically relocated. This includes
208 those not referenced by the primary GOT but included in
209 the "master" GOT. */
210 unsigned int global_count;
211 };
212
213 /* Another structure used to pass arguments for got entries traversal. */
214
215 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg
216 {
217 struct mips_got_info *g;
218 int value;
219 unsigned int needed_relocs;
220 struct bfd_link_info *info;
221 };
222
223 /* A structure used to count TLS relocations or GOT entries, for GOT
224 entry or ELF symbol table traversal. */
225
226 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg
227 {
228 struct bfd_link_info *info;
229 unsigned int needed;
230 };
231
232 struct _mips_elf_section_data
233 {
234 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
235 union
236 {
237 struct mips_got_info *got_info;
238 bfd_byte *tdata;
239 } u;
240 };
241
242 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
243 ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
244
245 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
246 the dynamic symbols. */
247
248 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
249 {
250 /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
251 index. */
252 struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
253 /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a non-TLS
254 symbol with a GOT entry. */
255 long min_got_dynindx;
256 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
257 with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
258 with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs). */
259 long max_unref_got_dynindx;
260 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index not corresponding to a
261 symbol without a GOT entry. */
262 long max_non_got_dynindx;
263 };
264
265 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
266 the global hash table. */
267
268 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
269 {
270 struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
271
272 /* External symbol information. */
273 EXTR esym;
274
275 /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
276 this symbol. */
277 unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
278
279 /* If the R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 reloc is against
280 a readonly section. */
281 bfd_boolean readonly_reloc;
282
283 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
284 related to taking the function's address, i.e. any but
285 R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones -- see "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition",
286 p. 4-20. */
287 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub;
288
289 /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
290 16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
291 asection *fn_stub;
292
293 /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is set if this symbol appears
294 in any relocs other than a 16 bit call. */
295 bfd_boolean need_fn_stub;
296
297 /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
298 32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
299 asection *call_stub;
300
301 /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
302 being called returns a floating point value. */
303 asection *call_fp_stub;
304
305 /* Are we forced local? This will only be set if we have converted
306 the initial global GOT entry to a local GOT entry. */
307 bfd_boolean forced_local;
308
309 /* Are we referenced by some kind of relocation? */
310 bfd_boolean is_relocation_target;
311
312 /* Are we referenced by branch relocations? */
313 bfd_boolean is_branch_target;
314
315 #define GOT_NORMAL 0
316 #define GOT_TLS_GD 1
317 #define GOT_TLS_LDM 2
318 #define GOT_TLS_IE 4
319 #define GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE 0x40
320 #define GOT_TLS_DONE 0x80
321 unsigned char tls_type;
322 /* This is only used in single-GOT mode; in multi-GOT mode there
323 is one mips_got_entry per GOT entry, so the offset is stored
324 there. In single-GOT mode there may be many mips_got_entry
325 structures all referring to the same GOT slot. It might be
326 possible to use root.got.offset instead, but that field is
327 overloaded already. */
328 bfd_vma tls_got_offset;
329 };
330
331 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
332
333 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
334 {
335 struct elf_link_hash_table root;
336 #if 0
337 /* We no longer use this. */
338 /* String section indices for the dynamic section symbols. */
339 bfd_size_type dynsym_sec_strindex[SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES];
340 #endif
341 /* The number of .rtproc entries. */
342 bfd_size_type procedure_count;
343 /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT). */
344 bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
345 /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic
346 entry is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5. */
347 bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
348 /* This is the value of the __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol. */
349 bfd_vma rld_value;
350 /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections. */
351 bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
352 /* True if we've computed the size of the GOT. */
353 bfd_boolean computed_got_sizes;
354 /* True if we're generating code for VxWorks. */
355 bfd_boolean is_vxworks;
356 /* True if we already reported the small-data section overflow. */
357 bfd_boolean small_data_overflow_reported;
358 /* Shortcuts to some dynamic sections, or NULL if they are not
359 being used. */
360 asection *srelbss;
361 asection *sdynbss;
362 asection *srelplt;
363 asection *srelplt2;
364 asection *sgotplt;
365 asection *splt;
366 /* The size of the PLT header in bytes (VxWorks only). */
367 bfd_vma plt_header_size;
368 /* The size of a PLT entry in bytes (VxWorks only). */
369 bfd_vma plt_entry_size;
370 /* The size of a function stub entry in bytes. */
371 bfd_vma function_stub_size;
372 };
373
374 #define TLS_RELOC_P(r_type) \
375 (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32 \
376 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 \
377 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32 \
378 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 \
379 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD \
380 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM \
381 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
382 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
383 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL \
384 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32 \
385 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 \
386 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
387 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16)
388
389 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym. */
390
391 struct extsym_info
392 {
393 bfd *abfd;
394 struct bfd_link_info *info;
395 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
396 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
397 bfd_boolean failed;
398 };
399
400 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5. */
401
402 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
403 {
404 "_procedure_table",
405 "_procedure_string_table",
406 "_procedure_table_size",
407 NULL
408 };
409
410 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
411 IRIX5. */
412
413 typedef struct
414 {
415 unsigned long id1; /* Always one? */
416 unsigned long num; /* Number of compact relocation entries. */
417 unsigned long id2; /* Always two? */
418 unsigned long offset; /* The file offset of the first relocation. */
419 unsigned long reserved0; /* Zero? */
420 unsigned long reserved1; /* Zero? */
421 } Elf32_compact_rel;
422
423 typedef struct
424 {
425 bfd_byte id1[4];
426 bfd_byte num[4];
427 bfd_byte id2[4];
428 bfd_byte offset[4];
429 bfd_byte reserved0[4];
430 bfd_byte reserved1[4];
431 } Elf32_External_compact_rel;
432
433 typedef struct
434 {
435 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
436 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
437 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
438 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
439 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
440 unsigned long vaddr; /* VADDR to be relocated. */
441 } Elf32_crinfo;
442
443 typedef struct
444 {
445 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
446 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
447 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
448 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
449 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
450 } Elf32_crinfo2;
451
452 typedef struct
453 {
454 bfd_byte info[4];
455 bfd_byte konst[4];
456 bfd_byte vaddr[4];
457 } Elf32_External_crinfo;
458
459 typedef struct
460 {
461 bfd_byte info[4];
462 bfd_byte konst[4];
463 } Elf32_External_crinfo2;
464
465 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo. */
466
467 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
468 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
469 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
470 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
471 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
472 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
473 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
474 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
475
476 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
477 formats. A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
478 fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2). */
479 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG 1
480 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT 0
481
482 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
483 has different meaning for each type:
484
485 (type) (konst)
486 CT_MIPS_REL32 Address in data
487 CT_MIPS_WORD Address in word (XXX)
488 CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO GP - vaddr
489 CT_MIPS_JMPAD Address to jump
490 */
491
492 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32 0xa
493 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD 0xb
494 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO 0xc
495 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD 0xd
496
497 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format) ((x).ctype = (format))
498 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type) ((x).rtype = (type))
499 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v) ((x).dist2to = (v))
500 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d) ((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
501 \f
502 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
503 loader for use by the static exception system. */
504
505 typedef struct runtime_pdr {
506 bfd_vma adr; /* Memory address of start of procedure. */
507 long regmask; /* Save register mask. */
508 long regoffset; /* Save register offset. */
509 long fregmask; /* Save floating point register mask. */
510 long fregoffset; /* Save floating point register offset. */
511 long frameoffset; /* Frame size. */
512 short framereg; /* Frame pointer register. */
513 short pcreg; /* Offset or reg of return pc. */
514 long irpss; /* Index into the runtime string table. */
515 long reserved;
516 struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array. */
517 } RPDR, *pRPDR;
518 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
519 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
520 \f
521 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
522 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, asection *,
523 bfd_vma, unsigned long, struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, int);
524 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
525 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
526 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
527 (bfd_vma);
528 static bfd_boolean mips16_stub_section_p
529 (bfd *, asection *);
530 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
531 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
532 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
533 bfd_vma *, asection *);
534 static hashval_t mips_elf_got_entry_hash
535 (const void *);
536 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
537 (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
538 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_for_ibfd
539 (struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
540
541 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records. */
542 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
543
544 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI. */
545 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
546 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
547
548 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI. */
549 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
550 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
551
552 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions. */
553 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
554
555 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for. */
556 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
557 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
558
559 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all. */
560 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
561 (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
562
563 /* The name of the options section. */
564 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
565 (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
566
567 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section.
568 Some IRIX system files do not use MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME. */
569 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
570 (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.options") == 0 || strcmp (NAME, ".options") == 0)
571
572 /* Whether the section is readonly. */
573 #define MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION(sec) \
574 ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY)) \
575 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))
576
577 /* The name of the stub section. */
578 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs"
579
580 /* The size of an external REL relocation. */
581 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
582 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
583
584 /* The size of an external RELA relocation. */
585 #define MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE(abfd) \
586 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rela)
587
588 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry. */
589 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
590 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
591
592 /* The size of a GOT entry. */
593 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
594 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
595
596 /* The size of a symbol-table entry. */
597 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
598 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
599
600 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two. */
601 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd) \
602 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
603
604 /* Get word-sized data. */
605 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
606 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
607
608 /* Put out word-sized data. */
609 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr) \
610 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
611 ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) \
612 : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
613
614 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry. */
615 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \
616 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val)
617
618 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela) \
619 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela))
620
621 /* Determine whether the internal relocation of index REL_IDX is REL
622 (zero) or RELA (non-zero). The assumption is that, if there are
623 two relocation sections for this section, one of them is REL and
624 the other is RELA. If the index of the relocation we're testing is
625 in range for the first relocation section, check that the external
626 relocation size is that for RELA. It is also assumed that, if
627 rel_idx is not in range for the first section, and this first
628 section contains REL relocs, then the relocation is in the second
629 section, that is RELA. */
630 #define MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P(abfd, sec, rel_idx) \
631 ((NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr) \
632 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel \
633 > (bfd_vma)(rel_idx)) \
634 == (elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr.sh_entsize \
635 == (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela) \
636 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela))))
637
638 /* The name of the dynamic relocation section. */
639 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME(INFO) \
640 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? ".rela.dyn" : ".rel.dyn")
641
642 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
643 from smaller values. Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement. */
644 #define MINUS_ONE (((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
645 #define MINUS_TWO (((bfd_vma)0) - 2)
646
647 /* The number of local .got entries we reserve. */
648 #define MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO(INFO) \
649 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 3 : 2)
650
651 /* The value to write into got[1] for SVR4 targets, to identify it is
652 a GNU object. The dynamic linker can then use got[1] to store the
653 module pointer. */
654 #define MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK(abfd) \
655 ((bfd_vma) 1 << (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 63 : 31))
656
657 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section. */
658 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(INFO) \
659 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 0x0 : 0x7ff0)
660
661 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
662 offsets from $gp. */
663 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(INFO) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (INFO) + 0x7fff)
664
665 /* Instructions which appear in a stub. */
666 #define STUB_LW(abfd) \
667 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
668 ? 0xdf998010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
669 : 0x8f998010)) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
670 #define STUB_MOVE(abfd) \
671 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
672 ? 0x03e0782d /* daddu t7,ra */ \
673 : 0x03e07821)) /* addu t7,ra */
674 #define STUB_LUI(VAL) (0x3c180000 + (VAL)) /* lui t8,VAL */
675 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809 /* jalr t9,ra */
676 #define STUB_ORI(VAL) (0x37180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,t8,VAL */
677 #define STUB_LI16U(VAL) (0x34180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,zero,VAL unsigned */
678 #define STUB_LI16S(abfd, VAL) \
679 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
680 ? (0x64180000 + (VAL)) /* daddiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */ \
681 : (0x24180000 + (VAL)))) /* addiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */
682
683 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 16
684 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 20
685
686 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
687 section. */
688
689 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) \
690 (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" \
691 : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" \
692 : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
693
694 #ifdef BFD64
695 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
696 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
697 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
698 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
699 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
700 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
701 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
702 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
703 #else
704 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
705 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
706 (ELF32_R_SYM (i))
707 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
708 (ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
709 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
710 (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
711 #endif
712 \f
713 /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
714 floating point arguments.
715
716 Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
717 copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
718 then jump to FNNAME. If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
719 call should be redirected to the stub instead. If no 32 bit
720 function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded. We need to
721 consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
722 if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
723 since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
724
725 Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
726 that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
727 regs and then jump to FNNAME. If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
728 then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
729 to the stub instead. If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
730 stub should be discarded.
731
732 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
733 which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
734 to the gp regs. These stubs store the return value in $18 while
735 calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
736 must arrange to save $18 around the call. (This case is not
737 needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
738 16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
739 $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
740
741 Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
742 Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally. Instead, the relocation
743 information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
744
745 We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table. */
746
747 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
748 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
749 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
750
751 #define FN_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, FN_STUB)
752 #define CALL_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_STUB)
753 #define CALL_FP_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_FP_STUB)
754 \f
755 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks executable. */
756 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry[] = {
757 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
758 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
759 0x8f390008, /* lw t9, 8(t9) */
760 0x00000000, /* nop */
761 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
762 0x00000000 /* nop */
763 };
764
765 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
766 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry[] = {
767 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
768 0x24180000, /* li t8, <pltindex> */
769 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(<.got.plt slot>) */
770 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(<.got.plt slot>) */
771 0x8f390000, /* lw t9, 0(t9) */
772 0x00000000, /* nop */
773 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
774 0x00000000 /* nop */
775 };
776
777 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks shared object. */
778 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[] = {
779 0x8f990008, /* lw t9, 8(gp) */
780 0x00000000, /* nop */
781 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
782 0x00000000, /* nop */
783 0x00000000, /* nop */
784 0x00000000 /* nop */
785 };
786
787 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
788 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry[] = {
789 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
790 0x24180000 /* li t8, <pltindex> */
791 };
792 \f
793 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
794
795 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow) \
796 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) \
797 elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create), \
798 (copy), (follow)))
799
800 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
801
802 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \
803 (elf_link_hash_traverse \
804 (&(table)->root, \
805 (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \
806 (info)))
807
808 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
809
810 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
811 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash))
812
813 /* Find the base offsets for thread-local storage in this object,
814 for GD/LD and IE/LE respectively. */
815
816 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
817 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
818
819 static bfd_vma
820 dtprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
821 {
822 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
823 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
824 return 0;
825 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
826 }
827
828 static bfd_vma
829 tprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
830 {
831 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
832 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
833 return 0;
834 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
835 }
836
837 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
838
839 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
840 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
841 struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
842 {
843 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
844 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
845
846 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
847 subclass. */
848 if (ret == NULL)
849 ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
850 if (ret == NULL)
851 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
852
853 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
854 ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
855 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
856 table, string));
857 if (ret != NULL)
858 {
859 /* Set local fields. */
860 memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
861 /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
862 not been set. -1 means there is no associated ifd. */
863 ret->esym.ifd = -2;
864 ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
865 ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
866 ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
867 ret->fn_stub = NULL;
868 ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
869 ret->call_stub = NULL;
870 ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
871 ret->forced_local = FALSE;
872 ret->is_branch_target = FALSE;
873 ret->is_relocation_target = FALSE;
874 ret->tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
875 }
876
877 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
878 }
879
880 bfd_boolean
881 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
882 {
883 if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
884 {
885 struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
886 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
887
888 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
889 if (sdata == NULL)
890 return FALSE;
891 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
892 }
893
894 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
895 }
896 \f
897 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
898 ecoff_debug_info structure. */
899
900 bfd_boolean
901 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
902 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
903 {
904 HDRR *symhdr;
905 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
906 char *ext_hdr;
907
908 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
909 memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
910
911 ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
912 if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
913 goto error_return;
914
915 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
916 swap->external_hdr_size))
917 goto error_return;
918
919 symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
920 (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
921
922 /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
923 read. */
924 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type) \
925 if (symhdr->count == 0) \
926 debug->ptr = NULL; \
927 else \
928 { \
929 bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count; \
930 debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt); \
931 if (debug->ptr == NULL) \
932 goto error_return; \
933 if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0 \
934 || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt) \
935 goto error_return; \
936 }
937
938 READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
939 READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
940 READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
941 READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
942 READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
943 READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
944 union aux_ext *);
945 READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
946 READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
947 READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
948 READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
949 READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
950 #undef READ
951
952 debug->fdr = NULL;
953
954 return TRUE;
955
956 error_return:
957 if (ext_hdr != NULL)
958 free (ext_hdr);
959 if (debug->line != NULL)
960 free (debug->line);
961 if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
962 free (debug->external_dnr);
963 if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
964 free (debug->external_pdr);
965 if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
966 free (debug->external_sym);
967 if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
968 free (debug->external_opt);
969 if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
970 free (debug->external_aux);
971 if (debug->ss != NULL)
972 free (debug->ss);
973 if (debug->ssext != NULL)
974 free (debug->ssext);
975 if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
976 free (debug->external_fdr);
977 if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
978 free (debug->external_rfd);
979 if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
980 free (debug->external_ext);
981 return FALSE;
982 }
983 \f
984 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output. */
985
986 static void
987 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
988 {
989 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
990 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
991 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
992 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
993 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
994 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
995
996 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
997 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
998
999 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
1000 }
1001
1002 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section. */
1003
1004 static bfd_boolean
1005 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
1006 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
1007 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
1008 {
1009 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
1010 HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
1011 RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
1012 struct rpdr_ext *erp;
1013 void *rtproc;
1014 struct pdr_ext *epdr;
1015 struct sym_ext *esym;
1016 char *ss, **sv;
1017 char *str;
1018 bfd_size_type size;
1019 bfd_size_type count;
1020 unsigned long sindex;
1021 unsigned long i;
1022 PDR pdr;
1023 SYMR sym;
1024 const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
1025
1026 epdr = NULL;
1027 rpdr = NULL;
1028 esym = NULL;
1029 ss = NULL;
1030 sv = NULL;
1031
1032 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
1033
1034 sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1035 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1036 if (count > 0)
1037 {
1038 size = swap->external_pdr_size;
1039
1040 epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1041 if (epdr == NULL)
1042 goto error_return;
1043
1044 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
1045 goto error_return;
1046
1047 size = sizeof (RPDR);
1048 rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1049 if (rpdr == NULL)
1050 goto error_return;
1051
1052 size = sizeof (char *);
1053 sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1054 if (sv == NULL)
1055 goto error_return;
1056
1057 count = hdr->isymMax;
1058 size = swap->external_sym_size;
1059 esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1060 if (esym == NULL)
1061 goto error_return;
1062
1063 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
1064 goto error_return;
1065
1066 count = hdr->issMax;
1067 ss = bfd_malloc (count);
1068 if (ss == NULL)
1069 goto error_return;
1070 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, (bfd_byte *) ss))
1071 goto error_return;
1072
1073 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1074 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
1075 {
1076 (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
1077 (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
1078 rp->adr = sym.value;
1079 rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
1080 rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
1081 rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
1082 rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
1083 rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
1084 rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
1085 rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
1086 rp->irpss = sindex;
1087 sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
1088 sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1089 }
1090 }
1091
1092 size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
1093 size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
1094 rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
1095 if (rtproc == NULL)
1096 {
1097 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
1098 goto error_return;
1099 }
1100
1101 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
1102
1103 erp = rtproc;
1104 memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
1105 erp++;
1106 str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
1107 strcpy (str, no_name_func);
1108 str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1109 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1110 {
1111 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
1112 strcpy (str, sv[i]);
1113 str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1114 }
1115 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
1116
1117 /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section. */
1118 s->size = size;
1119 s->contents = rtproc;
1120
1121 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
1122 matters, but someday it might). */
1123 s->map_head.link_order = NULL;
1124
1125 if (epdr != NULL)
1126 free (epdr);
1127 if (rpdr != NULL)
1128 free (rpdr);
1129 if (esym != NULL)
1130 free (esym);
1131 if (ss != NULL)
1132 free (ss);
1133 if (sv != NULL)
1134 free (sv);
1135
1136 return TRUE;
1137
1138 error_return:
1139 if (epdr != NULL)
1140 free (epdr);
1141 if (rpdr != NULL)
1142 free (rpdr);
1143 if (esym != NULL)
1144 free (esym);
1145 if (ss != NULL)
1146 free (ss);
1147 if (sv != NULL)
1148 free (sv);
1149 return FALSE;
1150 }
1151
1152 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
1153 discard them. */
1154
1155 static bfd_boolean
1156 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1157 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1158 {
1159 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1160 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1161
1162 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1163 && ! h->need_fn_stub)
1164 {
1165 /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
1166 are 16 bit calls. Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
1167 being included in the link. */
1168 h->fn_stub->size = 0;
1169 h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1170 h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1171 h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1172 }
1173
1174 if (h->call_stub != NULL
1175 && ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other))
1176 {
1177 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1178 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1179 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1180 h->call_stub->size = 0;
1181 h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1182 h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1183 h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1184 }
1185
1186 if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
1187 && ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other))
1188 {
1189 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1190 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1191 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1192 h->call_fp_stub->size = 0;
1193 h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1194 h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1195 h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1196 }
1197
1198 return TRUE;
1199 }
1200 \f
1201 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
1202 Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
1203 are 32 bits.
1204
1205 The format of these instructions is:
1206
1207 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1208 | JALX | X| Imm 20:16 | Imm 25:21 |
1209 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1210 | Immediate 15:0 |
1211 +-----------------------------------------------+
1212
1213 JALX is the 5-bit value 00011. X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
1214 Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
1215
1216 When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
1217 handled mostly like R_MIPS_26. In particular, the addend is
1218 stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
1219 (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
1220 R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
1221 always zero). However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
1222 16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value. In a
1223 big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
1224 file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
1225 This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
1226 instruction.
1227
1228 When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
1229 instruction stored as two 16-bit values. The addend A is the
1230 contents of the targ26 field. The calculation is the same as
1231 R_MIPS_26. When storing the calculated value, reorder the
1232 immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
1233 value as two 16-bit values.
1234
1235 To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
1236 defined as
1237
1238 big-endian:
1239 +--------+----------------------+
1240 | | |
1241 | | targ26-16 |
1242 |31 26|25 0|
1243 +--------+----------------------+
1244
1245 little-endian:
1246 +----------+------+-------------+
1247 | | | |
1248 | sub1 | | sub2 |
1249 |0 9|10 15|16 31|
1250 +----------+--------------------+
1251 where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
1252 ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
1253
1254 When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
1255 (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1256 When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
1257 let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1258 ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff)
1259
1260 R_MIPS16_GPREL is used for GP-relative addressing in mips16
1261 mode. A typical instruction will have a format like this:
1262
1263 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1264 | EXTEND | Imm 10:5 | Imm 15:11 |
1265 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1266 | Major | rx | ry | Imm 4:0 |
1267 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1268
1269 EXTEND is the five bit value 11110. Major is the instruction
1270 opcode.
1271
1272 This is handled exactly like R_MIPS_GPREL16, except that the
1273 addend is retrieved and stored as shown in this diagram; that
1274 is, the Imm fields above replace the V-rel16 field.
1275
1276 All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately. As
1277 above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
1278 little-endian system.
1279
1280 R_MIPS16_HI16 and R_MIPS16_LO16 are used in mips16 mode to
1281 access data when neither GP-relative nor PC-relative addressing
1282 can be used. They are handled like R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16,
1283 except that the addend is retrieved and stored as shown above
1284 for R_MIPS16_GPREL.
1285 */
1286 void
1287 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1288 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1289 {
1290 bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1291
1292 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1293 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1294 return;
1295
1296 /* Pick up the mips16 extend instruction and the real instruction. */
1297 extend = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data);
1298 insn = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data + 2);
1299 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1300 {
1301 if (jal_shuffle)
1302 val = ((extend & 0xfc00) << 16) | ((extend & 0x3e0) << 11)
1303 | ((extend & 0x1f) << 21) | insn;
1304 else
1305 val = extend << 16 | insn;
1306 }
1307 else
1308 val = ((extend & 0xf800) << 16) | ((insn & 0xffe0) << 11)
1309 | ((extend & 0x1f) << 11) | (extend & 0x7e0) | (insn & 0x1f);
1310 bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, data);
1311 }
1312
1313 void
1314 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1315 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1316 {
1317 bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1318
1319 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1320 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1321 return;
1322
1323 val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, data);
1324 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1325 {
1326 if (jal_shuffle)
1327 {
1328 insn = val & 0xffff;
1329 extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xfc00) | ((val >> 11) & 0x3e0)
1330 | ((val >> 21) & 0x1f);
1331 }
1332 else
1333 {
1334 insn = val & 0xffff;
1335 extend = val >> 16;
1336 }
1337 }
1338 else
1339 {
1340 insn = ((val >> 11) & 0xffe0) | (val & 0x1f);
1341 extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xf800) | ((val >> 11) & 0x1f) | (val & 0x7e0);
1342 }
1343 bfd_put_16 (abfd, insn, data + 2);
1344 bfd_put_16 (abfd, extend, data);
1345 }
1346
1347 bfd_reloc_status_type
1348 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1349 arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
1350 bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
1351 {
1352 bfd_vma relocation;
1353 bfd_signed_vma val;
1354 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1355
1356 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1357 relocation = 0;
1358 else
1359 relocation = symbol->value;
1360
1361 relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1362 relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
1363
1364 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1365 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1366
1367 /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol. */
1368 val = reloc_entry->addend;
1369
1370 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
1371
1372 /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value. If we
1373 are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
1374 an external symbol. */
1375 if (! relocatable
1376 || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1377 val += relocation - gp;
1378
1379 if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1380 {
1381 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1382 (bfd_byte *) data
1383 + reloc_entry->address);
1384 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1385 return status;
1386 }
1387 else
1388 reloc_entry->addend = val;
1389
1390 if (relocatable)
1391 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1392
1393 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1394 }
1395
1396 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
1397 R_MIPS_GOT16. REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
1398 that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
1399 INPUT_SECTION. */
1400
1401 struct mips_hi16
1402 {
1403 struct mips_hi16 *next;
1404 bfd_byte *data;
1405 asection *input_section;
1406 arelent rel;
1407 };
1408
1409 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable. */
1410
1411 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
1412
1413 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations. We can only
1414 calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
1415 *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
1416
1417 The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
1418 However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
1419 *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16. This significantly
1420 simplies the relocation handling in gcc. */
1421
1422 bfd_reloc_status_type
1423 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1424 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
1425 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1426 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1427 {
1428 struct mips_hi16 *n;
1429
1430 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1431 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1432
1433 n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
1434 if (n == NULL)
1435 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1436
1437 n->next = mips_hi16_list;
1438 n->data = data;
1439 n->input_section = input_section;
1440 n->rel = *reloc_entry;
1441 mips_hi16_list = n;
1442
1443 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1444 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1445
1446 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1447 }
1448
1449 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations. This is just
1450 like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
1451 treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols. */
1452
1453 bfd_reloc_status_type
1454 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1455 void *data, asection *input_section,
1456 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1457 {
1458 if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
1459 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
1460 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
1461 /* The relocation is against a global symbol. */
1462 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1463 input_section, output_bfd,
1464 error_message);
1465
1466 return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1467 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1468 }
1469
1470 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations. The *LO16 itself
1471 is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
1472 any partnering high-part relocations as well. */
1473
1474 bfd_reloc_status_type
1475 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1476 void *data, asection *input_section,
1477 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1478 {
1479 bfd_vma vallo;
1480 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1481
1482 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1483 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1484
1485 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1486 location);
1487 vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, location);
1488 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1489 location);
1490
1491 while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
1492 {
1493 bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
1494 struct mips_hi16 *hi;
1495
1496 hi = mips_hi16_list;
1497
1498 /* R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case. We
1499 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS_HI16
1500 relocation (with a rightshift of 16). However, since GOT16
1501 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
1502 has a rightshift of 0. */
1503 if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
1504 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
1505
1506 /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number. Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
1507 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part. */
1508 hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
1509
1510 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
1511 hi->input_section, output_bfd,
1512 error_message);
1513 if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
1514 return ret;
1515
1516 mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
1517 free (hi);
1518 }
1519
1520 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1521 input_section, output_bfd,
1522 error_message);
1523 }
1524
1525 /* A generic howto special_function. This calculates and installs the
1526 relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
1527 bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation. */
1528
1529 bfd_reloc_status_type
1530 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1531 asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1532 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1533 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1534 {
1535 bfd_signed_vma val;
1536 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1537 bfd_boolean relocatable;
1538
1539 relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
1540
1541 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1542 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1543
1544 /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL. */
1545 val = 0;
1546 if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1547 {
1548 /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
1549 relocation against a section symbol. Add in the section's
1550 offset or address. */
1551 val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1552 val += symbol->section->output_offset;
1553 }
1554
1555 if (!relocatable)
1556 {
1557 /* We're calculating the final field value. Add in the symbol's value
1558 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself. */
1559 val += symbol->value;
1560 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
1561 {
1562 val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
1563 val -= input_section->output_offset;
1564 val -= reloc_entry->address;
1565 }
1566 }
1567
1568 /* VAL is now the final adjustment. If we're keeping this relocation
1569 in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
1570 we just need to add VAL to that addend. Otherwise we need to add
1571 VAL to the relocation field itself. */
1572 if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1573 reloc_entry->addend += val;
1574 else
1575 {
1576 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1577
1578 /* Add in the separate addend, if any. */
1579 val += reloc_entry->addend;
1580
1581 /* Add VAL to the relocation field. */
1582 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1583 location);
1584 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1585 location);
1586 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1587 location);
1588
1589 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1590 return status;
1591 }
1592
1593 if (relocatable)
1594 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1595
1596 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1597 }
1598 \f
1599 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section. Note that these routines rely
1600 on the equivalence of the two elements of the union. */
1601
1602 static void
1603 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
1604 Elf32_gptab *in)
1605 {
1606 in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1607 in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1608 }
1609
1610 static void
1611 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
1612 Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
1613 {
1614 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1615 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1616 }
1617
1618 static void
1619 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
1620 Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
1621 {
1622 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
1623 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
1624 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
1625 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
1626 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
1627 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
1628 }
1629
1630 static void
1631 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
1632 Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
1633 {
1634 unsigned long l;
1635
1636 l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
1637 | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
1638 | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
1639 | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
1640 H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
1641 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
1642 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
1643 }
1644 \f
1645 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure. These
1646 routines swap this structure in and out. They are used outside of
1647 BFD, so they are globally visible. */
1648
1649 void
1650 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
1651 Elf32_RegInfo *in)
1652 {
1653 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1654 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1655 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1656 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1657 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1658 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1659 }
1660
1661 void
1662 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
1663 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
1664 {
1665 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1666 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1667 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1668 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1669 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1670 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1671 }
1672
1673 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
1674 information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure. These routines swap
1675 them in and out. They are globally visible because they are used
1676 outside of BFD. These routines are here so that gas can call them
1677 without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included. */
1678
1679 void
1680 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
1681 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
1682 {
1683 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1684 in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
1685 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1686 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1687 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1688 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1689 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1690 }
1691
1692 void
1693 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
1694 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
1695 {
1696 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1697 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
1698 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1699 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1700 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1701 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1702 H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1703 }
1704
1705 /* Swap in an options header. */
1706
1707 void
1708 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
1709 Elf_Internal_Options *in)
1710 {
1711 in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
1712 in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
1713 in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
1714 in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
1715 }
1716
1717 /* Swap out an options header. */
1718
1719 void
1720 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
1721 Elf_External_Options *ex)
1722 {
1723 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
1724 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
1725 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
1726 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
1727 }
1728 \f
1729 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
1730 entries by increasing r_symndx value. */
1731
1732 static int
1733 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
1734 {
1735 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
1736 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
1737 int diff;
1738
1739 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
1740 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
1741
1742 diff = ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
1743 if (diff != 0)
1744 return diff;
1745
1746 if (int_reloc1.r_offset < int_reloc2.r_offset)
1747 return -1;
1748 if (int_reloc1.r_offset > int_reloc2.r_offset)
1749 return 1;
1750 return 0;
1751 }
1752
1753 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations. */
1754
1755 static int
1756 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1757 const void *arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1758 {
1759 #ifdef BFD64
1760 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
1761 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
1762
1763 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1764 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
1765 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1766 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
1767
1768 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) < ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
1769 return -1;
1770 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) > ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
1771 return 1;
1772
1773 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset < int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
1774 return -1;
1775 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset > int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
1776 return 1;
1777 return 0;
1778 #else
1779 abort ();
1780 #endif
1781 }
1782
1783
1784 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
1785 information. It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse. The
1786 ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
1787 symbol information. Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
1788 whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
1789 tables may wind up being different. We must sort out the external
1790 symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
1791 section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
1792 can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
1793 required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
1794 Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
1795 stripped but required by a reloc. In particular, it can not happen
1796 when generating a final executable. */
1797
1798 static bfd_boolean
1799 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
1800 {
1801 struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
1802 bfd_boolean strip;
1803 asection *sec, *output_section;
1804
1805 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1806 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1807
1808 if (h->root.indx == -2)
1809 strip = FALSE;
1810 else if ((h->root.def_dynamic
1811 || h->root.ref_dynamic
1812 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
1813 && !h->root.def_regular
1814 && !h->root.ref_regular)
1815 strip = TRUE;
1816 else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
1817 || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
1818 && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
1819 h->root.root.root.string,
1820 FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
1821 strip = TRUE;
1822 else
1823 strip = FALSE;
1824
1825 if (strip)
1826 return TRUE;
1827
1828 if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
1829 {
1830 h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
1831 h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
1832 h->esym.weakext = 0;
1833 h->esym.reserved = 0;
1834 h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
1835 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1836 h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
1837
1838 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
1839 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
1840 {
1841 const char *name;
1842
1843 /* Use undefined class. Also, set class and type for some
1844 special symbols. */
1845 name = h->root.root.root.string;
1846 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
1847 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
1848 {
1849 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1850 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1851 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1852 }
1853 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
1854 {
1855 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1856 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1857 h->esym.asym.value =
1858 mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
1859 }
1860 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd))
1861 {
1862 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1863 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1864 h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd);
1865 }
1866 else
1867 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1868 }
1869 else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
1870 && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1871 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1872 else
1873 {
1874 const char *name;
1875
1876 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1877 output_section = sec->output_section;
1878
1879 /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
1880 the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null. */
1881 if (output_section == NULL)
1882 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1883 else
1884 {
1885 name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
1886
1887 if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
1888 h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
1889 else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
1890 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1891 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
1892 h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
1893 else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
1894 || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
1895 h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
1896 else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
1897 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1898 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
1899 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1900 else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
1901 h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
1902 else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
1903 h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
1904 else
1905 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1906 }
1907 }
1908
1909 h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
1910 h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
1911 }
1912
1913 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
1914 h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
1915 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1916 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1917 {
1918 if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
1919 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1920 else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
1921 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1922
1923 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1924 output_section = sec->output_section;
1925 if (output_section != NULL)
1926 h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
1927 + sec->output_offset
1928 + output_section->vma);
1929 else
1930 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1931 }
1932 else if (h->root.needs_plt)
1933 {
1934 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
1935 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub = h->no_fn_stub;
1936
1937 while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
1938 {
1939 hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
1940 no_fn_stub = no_fn_stub || hd->no_fn_stub;
1941 }
1942
1943 if (!no_fn_stub)
1944 {
1945 /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub. */
1946 h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
1947 sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
1948 if (sec == NULL)
1949 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1950 else
1951 {
1952 output_section = sec->output_section;
1953 if (output_section != NULL)
1954 h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.offset
1955 + sec->output_offset
1956 + output_section->vma);
1957 else
1958 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1959 }
1960 }
1961 }
1962
1963 if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
1964 h->root.root.root.string,
1965 &h->esym))
1966 {
1967 einfo->failed = TRUE;
1968 return FALSE;
1969 }
1970
1971 return TRUE;
1972 }
1973
1974 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries. */
1975
1976 static int
1977 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
1978 {
1979 const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
1980 const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
1981
1982 return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
1983 }
1984 \f
1985 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table. */
1986
1987 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
1988 hash number. */
1989
1990 static INLINE hashval_t
1991 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
1992 {
1993 #ifdef BFD64
1994 return addr + (addr >> 32);
1995 #else
1996 return addr;
1997 #endif
1998 }
1999
2000 /* got_entries only match if they're identical, except for gotidx, so
2001 use all fields to compute the hash, and compare the appropriate
2002 union members. */
2003
2004 static hashval_t
2005 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2006 {
2007 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
2008
2009 return entry->symndx
2010 + ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) << 17)
2011 + (! entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
2012 : entry->abfd->id
2013 + (entry->symndx >= 0 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)
2014 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
2015 }
2016
2017 static int
2018 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2019 {
2020 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
2021 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
2022
2023 /* An LDM entry can only match another LDM entry. */
2024 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2025 return 0;
2026
2027 return e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->symndx == e2->symndx
2028 && (! e1->abfd ? e1->d.address == e2->d.address
2029 : e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
2030 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
2031 }
2032
2033 /* multi_got_entries are still a match in the case of global objects,
2034 even if the input bfd in which they're referenced differs, so the
2035 hash computation and compare functions are adjusted
2036 accordingly. */
2037
2038 static hashval_t
2039 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2040 {
2041 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
2042
2043 return entry->symndx
2044 + (! entry->abfd
2045 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
2046 : entry->symndx >= 0
2047 ? ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2048 ? (GOT_TLS_LDM << 17)
2049 : (entry->abfd->id
2050 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)))
2051 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash);
2052 }
2053
2054 static int
2055 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2056 {
2057 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
2058 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
2059
2060 /* Any two LDM entries match. */
2061 if (e1->tls_type & e2->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2062 return 1;
2063
2064 /* Nothing else matches an LDM entry. */
2065 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2066 return 0;
2067
2068 return e1->symndx == e2->symndx
2069 && (e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
2070 : e1->abfd == NULL || e2->abfd == NULL
2071 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
2072 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
2073 }
2074
2075 static hashval_t
2076 mips_got_page_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2077 {
2078 const struct mips_got_page_entry *entry;
2079
2080 entry = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry_;
2081 return entry->abfd->id + entry->symndx;
2082 }
2083
2084 static int
2085 mips_got_page_entry_eq (const void *entry1_, const void *entry2_)
2086 {
2087 const struct mips_got_page_entry *entry1, *entry2;
2088
2089 entry1 = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry1_;
2090 entry2 = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry2_;
2091 return entry1->abfd == entry2->abfd && entry1->symndx == entry2->symndx;
2092 }
2093 \f
2094 /* Return the dynamic relocation section. If it doesn't exist, try to
2095 create a new it if CREATE_P, otherwise return NULL. Also return NULL
2096 if creation fails. */
2097
2098 static asection *
2099 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_boolean create_p)
2100 {
2101 const char *dname;
2102 asection *sreloc;
2103 bfd *dynobj;
2104
2105 dname = MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info);
2106 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2107 sreloc = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, dname);
2108 if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
2109 {
2110 sreloc = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, dname,
2111 (SEC_ALLOC
2112 | SEC_LOAD
2113 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2114 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2115 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
2116 | SEC_READONLY));
2117 if (sreloc == NULL
2118 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
2119 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
2120 return NULL;
2121 }
2122 return sreloc;
2123 }
2124
2125 /* Returns the GOT section for ABFD. */
2126
2127 static asection *
2128 mips_elf_got_section (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)
2129 {
2130 asection *sgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
2131 if (sgot == NULL
2132 || (! maybe_excluded && (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0))
2133 return NULL;
2134 return sgot;
2135 }
2136
2137 /* Returns the GOT information associated with the link indicated by
2138 INFO. If SGOTP is non-NULL, it is filled in with the GOT
2139 section. */
2140
2141 static struct mips_got_info *
2142 mips_elf_got_info (bfd *abfd, asection **sgotp)
2143 {
2144 asection *sgot;
2145 struct mips_got_info *g;
2146
2147 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
2148 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
2149 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
2150 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
2151 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2152
2153 if (sgotp)
2154 *sgotp = (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0 ? sgot : NULL;
2155
2156 return g;
2157 }
2158
2159 /* Count the number of relocations needed for a TLS GOT entry, with
2160 access types from TLS_TYPE, and symbol H (or a local symbol if H
2161 is NULL). */
2162
2163 static int
2164 mips_tls_got_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned char tls_type,
2165 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2166 {
2167 int indx = 0;
2168 int ret = 0;
2169 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2170 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2171
2172 if (h && WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, h)
2173 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
2174 indx = h->dynindx;
2175
2176 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2177 && (h == NULL
2178 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
2179 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2180 need_relocs = TRUE;
2181
2182 if (!need_relocs)
2183 return FALSE;
2184
2185 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2186 {
2187 ret++;
2188 if (indx != 0)
2189 ret++;
2190 }
2191
2192 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2193 ret++;
2194
2195 if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) && info->shared)
2196 ret++;
2197
2198 return ret;
2199 }
2200
2201 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the GOT entry in
2202 ARG1, if it describes a local symbol. */
2203
2204 static int
2205 mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs (void **arg1, void *arg2)
2206 {
2207 struct mips_got_entry *entry = * (struct mips_got_entry **) arg1;
2208 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2209
2210 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx != -1)
2211 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type, NULL);
2212
2213 return 1;
2214 }
2215
2216 /* Count the number of TLS GOT entries required for the global (or
2217 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2218
2219 static int
2220 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2221 {
2222 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2223 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2224 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2225
2226 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2227 arg->needed += 2;
2228 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2229 arg->needed += 1;
2230
2231 return 1;
2232 }
2233
2234 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the global (or
2235 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2236
2237 static int
2238 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2239 {
2240 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2241 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2242 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2243
2244 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, hm->tls_type, &hm->root);
2245
2246 return 1;
2247 }
2248
2249 /* Output a simple dynamic relocation into SRELOC. */
2250
2251 static void
2252 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
2253 asection *sreloc,
2254 unsigned long indx,
2255 int r_type,
2256 bfd_vma offset)
2257 {
2258 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
2259
2260 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
2261
2262 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, indx, r_type);
2263 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
2264
2265 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
2266 {
2267 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
2268 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2269 (sreloc->contents
2270 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
2271 }
2272 else
2273 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
2274 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2275 (sreloc->contents
2276 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
2277 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
2278 }
2279
2280 /* Initialize a set of TLS GOT entries for one symbol. */
2281
2282 static void
2283 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_offset,
2284 unsigned char *tls_type_p,
2285 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2286 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2287 bfd_vma value)
2288 {
2289 int indx;
2290 asection *sreloc, *sgot;
2291 bfd_vma offset, offset2;
2292 bfd *dynobj;
2293 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2294
2295 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2296 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
2297
2298 indx = 0;
2299 if (h != NULL)
2300 {
2301 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2302
2303 if (WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, &h->root)
2304 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
2305 indx = h->root.dynindx;
2306 }
2307
2308 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_DONE)
2309 return;
2310
2311 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2312 && (h == NULL
2313 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT
2314 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2315 need_relocs = TRUE;
2316
2317 /* MINUS_ONE means the symbol is not defined in this object. It may not
2318 be defined at all; assume that the value doesn't matter in that
2319 case. Otherwise complain if we would use the value. */
2320 BFD_ASSERT (value != MINUS_ONE || (indx != 0 && need_relocs)
2321 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak);
2322
2323 /* Emit necessary relocations. */
2324 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
2325
2326 /* General Dynamic. */
2327 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_GD)
2328 {
2329 offset = got_offset;
2330 offset2 = offset + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2331
2332 if (need_relocs)
2333 {
2334 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2335 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2336 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2337 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2338
2339 if (indx)
2340 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2341 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2342 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32,
2343 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset2);
2344 else
2345 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2346 sgot->contents + offset2);
2347 }
2348 else
2349 {
2350 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2351 sgot->contents + offset);
2352 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2353 sgot->contents + offset2);
2354 }
2355
2356 got_offset += 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2357 }
2358
2359 /* Initial Exec model. */
2360 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_IE)
2361 {
2362 offset = got_offset;
2363
2364 if (need_relocs)
2365 {
2366 if (indx == 0)
2367 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma,
2368 sgot->contents + offset);
2369 else
2370 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2371 sgot->contents + offset);
2372
2373 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2374 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2375 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32,
2376 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2377 }
2378 else
2379 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - tprel_base (info),
2380 sgot->contents + offset);
2381 }
2382
2383 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2384 {
2385 /* The initial offset is zero, and the LD offsets will include the
2386 bias by DTP_OFFSET. */
2387 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2388 sgot->contents + got_offset
2389 + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2390
2391 if (!info->shared)
2392 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2393 sgot->contents + got_offset);
2394 else
2395 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2396 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2397 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2398 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
2399 }
2400
2401 *tls_type_p |= GOT_TLS_DONE;
2402 }
2403
2404 /* Return the GOT index to use for a relocation of type R_TYPE against
2405 a symbol accessed using TLS_TYPE models. The GOT entries for this
2406 symbol in this GOT start at GOT_INDEX. This function initializes the
2407 GOT entries and corresponding relocations. */
2408
2409 static bfd_vma
2410 mips_tls_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_index, unsigned char *tls_type,
2411 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2412 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, bfd_vma symbol)
2413 {
2414 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
2415 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM);
2416
2417 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (abfd, got_index, tls_type, info, h, symbol);
2418
2419 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL)
2420 {
2421 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE);
2422 if (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2423 return got_index + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2424 else
2425 return got_index;
2426 }
2427
2428 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD)
2429 {
2430 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD);
2431 return got_index;
2432 }
2433
2434 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2435 {
2436 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM);
2437 return got_index;
2438 }
2439
2440 return got_index;
2441 }
2442
2443 /* Return the offset from _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ of the .got.plt entry
2444 for global symbol H. .got.plt comes before the GOT, so the offset
2445 will be negative. */
2446
2447 static bfd_vma
2448 mips_elf_gotplt_index (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2449 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2450 {
2451 bfd_vma plt_index, got_address, got_value;
2452 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2453
2454 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
2455 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1);
2456
2457 /* Calculate the index of the symbol's PLT entry. */
2458 plt_index = (h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size) / htab->plt_entry_size;
2459
2460 /* Calculate the address of the associated .got.plt entry. */
2461 got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
2462 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
2463 + plt_index * 4);
2464
2465 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
2466 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
2467 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2468 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
2469
2470 return got_address - got_value;
2471 }
2472
2473 /* Return the GOT offset for address VALUE. If there is not yet a GOT
2474 entry for this value, create one. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol,
2475 create a TLS GOT entry instead. Return -1 if no satisfactory GOT
2476 offset can be found. */
2477
2478 static bfd_vma
2479 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2480 bfd_vma value, unsigned long r_symndx,
2481 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
2482 {
2483 asection *sgot;
2484 struct mips_got_info *g;
2485 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2486
2487 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2488
2489 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2490 value, r_symndx, h, r_type);
2491 if (!entry)
2492 return MINUS_ONE;
2493
2494 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2495 {
2496 if (entry->symndx == -1 && g->next == NULL)
2497 /* A type (3) entry in the single-GOT case. We use the symbol's
2498 hash table entry to track the index. */
2499 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, h->tls_got_offset, &h->tls_type,
2500 r_type, info, h, value);
2501 else
2502 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, entry->gotidx, &entry->tls_type,
2503 r_type, info, h, value);
2504 }
2505 else
2506 return entry->gotidx;
2507 }
2508
2509 /* Returns the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H. */
2510
2511 static bfd_vma
2512 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2513 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2514 {
2515 bfd_vma index;
2516 asection *sgot;
2517 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
2518 long global_got_dynindx = 0;
2519
2520 gg = g = mips_elf_got_info (abfd, &sgot);
2521 if (g->bfd2got && ibfd)
2522 {
2523 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
2524
2525 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= 0);
2526
2527 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
2528 if (g->next != gg || TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2529 {
2530 e.abfd = ibfd;
2531 e.symndx = -1;
2532 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
2533 e.tls_type = 0;
2534
2535 p = htab_find (g->got_entries, &e);
2536
2537 BFD_ASSERT (p->gotidx > 0);
2538
2539 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2540 {
2541 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2542 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2543 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2544 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2545 value = (h->root.u.def.value
2546 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2547 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2548
2549 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, p->gotidx, &p->tls_type, r_type,
2550 info, e.d.h, value);
2551 }
2552 else
2553 return p->gotidx;
2554 }
2555 }
2556
2557 if (gg->global_gotsym != NULL)
2558 global_got_dynindx = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
2559
2560 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2561 {
2562 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2563 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2564 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2565
2566 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2567 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2568 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2569 value = (h->root.u.def.value
2570 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2571 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2572
2573 index = mips_tls_got_index (abfd, hm->tls_got_offset, &hm->tls_type,
2574 r_type, info, hm, value);
2575 }
2576 else
2577 {
2578 /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
2579 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
2580 indices into the GOT. That makes it easy to calculate the GOT
2581 offset. */
2582 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
2583 index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
2584 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2585 }
2586 BFD_ASSERT (index < sgot->size);
2587
2588 return index;
2589 }
2590
2591 /* Find a GOT page entry that points to within 32KB of VALUE. These
2592 entries are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
2593 within 32KB of GP. Return the index of the GOT entry, or -1 if no
2594 entry could be created. If OFFSETP is nonnull, use it to return the
2595 offset of the GOT entry from VALUE. */
2596
2597 static bfd_vma
2598 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2599 bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
2600 {
2601 asection *sgot;
2602 struct mips_got_info *g;
2603 bfd_vma page, index;
2604 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2605
2606 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2607
2608 page = (value + 0x8000) & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
2609 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2610 page, 0, NULL, R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
2611
2612 if (!entry)
2613 return MINUS_ONE;
2614
2615 index = entry->gotidx;
2616
2617 if (offsetp)
2618 *offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
2619
2620 return index;
2621 }
2622
2623 /* Find a local GOT entry for an R_MIPS_GOT16 relocation against VALUE.
2624 EXTERNAL is true if the relocation was against a global symbol
2625 that has been forced local. */
2626
2627 static bfd_vma
2628 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2629 bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
2630 {
2631 asection *sgot;
2632 struct mips_got_info *g;
2633 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2634
2635 /* GOT16 relocations against local symbols are followed by a LO16
2636 relocation; those against global symbols are not. Thus if the
2637 symbol was originally local, the GOT16 relocation should load the
2638 equivalent of %hi(VALUE), otherwise it should load VALUE itself. */
2639 if (! external)
2640 value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
2641
2642 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2643
2644 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2645 value, 0, NULL, R_MIPS_GOT16);
2646 if (entry)
2647 return entry->gotidx;
2648 else
2649 return MINUS_ONE;
2650 }
2651
2652 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
2653 in the GOT. */
2654
2655 static bfd_vma
2656 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (bfd *dynobj, bfd *output_bfd,
2657 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma index)
2658 {
2659 asection *sgot;
2660 bfd_vma gp;
2661 struct mips_got_info *g;
2662
2663 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
2664 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
2665 + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, g, input_bfd);
2666
2667 return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + index - gp;
2668 }
2669
2670 /* Create and return a local GOT entry for VALUE, which was calculated
2671 from a symbol belonging to INPUT_SECTON. Return NULL if it could not
2672 be created. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol, create a TLS entry
2673 instead. */
2674
2675 static struct mips_got_entry *
2676 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2677 bfd *ibfd, struct mips_got_info *gg,
2678 asection *sgot, bfd_vma value,
2679 unsigned long r_symndx,
2680 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2681 int r_type)
2682 {
2683 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2684 struct mips_got_info *g;
2685 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2686
2687 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
2688
2689 entry.abfd = NULL;
2690 entry.symndx = -1;
2691 entry.d.address = value;
2692 entry.tls_type = 0;
2693
2694 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, ibfd);
2695 if (g == NULL)
2696 {
2697 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, abfd);
2698 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2699 }
2700
2701 /* We might have a symbol, H, if it has been forced local. Use the
2702 global entry then. It doesn't matter whether an entry is local
2703 or global for TLS, since the dynamic linker does not
2704 automatically relocate TLS GOT entries. */
2705 BFD_ASSERT (h == NULL || h->root.forced_local);
2706 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2707 {
2708 struct mips_got_entry *p;
2709
2710 entry.abfd = ibfd;
2711 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2712 {
2713 entry.tls_type = GOT_TLS_LDM;
2714 entry.symndx = 0;
2715 entry.d.addend = 0;
2716 }
2717 else if (h == NULL)
2718 {
2719 entry.symndx = r_symndx;
2720 entry.d.addend = 0;
2721 }
2722 else
2723 entry.d.h = h;
2724
2725 p = (struct mips_got_entry *)
2726 htab_find (g->got_entries, &entry);
2727
2728 BFD_ASSERT (p);
2729 return p;
2730 }
2731
2732 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2733 INSERT);
2734 if (*loc)
2735 return *loc;
2736
2737 entry.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_gotno++;
2738 entry.tls_type = 0;
2739
2740 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2741
2742 if (! *loc)
2743 return NULL;
2744
2745 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2746
2747 if (g->assigned_gotno > g->local_gotno)
2748 {
2749 (*loc)->gotidx = -1;
2750 /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT. */
2751 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2752 (_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
2753 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2754 return NULL;
2755 }
2756
2757 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value,
2758 (sgot->contents + entry.gotidx));
2759
2760 /* These GOT entries need a dynamic relocation on VxWorks. */
2761 if (htab->is_vxworks)
2762 {
2763 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
2764 asection *s;
2765 bfd_byte *loc;
2766 bfd_vma got_address;
2767
2768 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
2769 got_address = (sgot->output_section->vma
2770 + sgot->output_offset
2771 + entry.gotidx);
2772
2773 loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
2774 outrel.r_offset = got_address;
2775 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_MIPS_32);
2776 outrel.r_addend = value;
2777 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
2778 }
2779
2780 return *loc;
2781 }
2782
2783 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
2784 appear towards the end. This reduces the amount of GOT space
2785 required. MAX_LOCAL is used to set the number of local symbols
2786 known to be in the dynamic symbol table. During
2787 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections, this value is 1. Afterward, the
2788 section symbols are added and the count is higher. */
2789
2790 static bfd_boolean
2791 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned long max_local)
2792 {
2793 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
2794 struct mips_got_info *g;
2795 bfd *dynobj;
2796
2797 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2798
2799 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
2800
2801 hsd.low = NULL;
2802 hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx =
2803 hsd.min_got_dynindx = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
2804 /* In the multi-got case, assigned_gotno of the master got_info
2805 indicate the number of entries that aren't referenced in the
2806 primary GOT, but that must have entries because there are
2807 dynamic relocations that reference it. Since they aren't
2808 referenced, we move them to the end of the GOT, so that they
2809 don't prevent other entries that are referenced from getting
2810 too large offsets. */
2811 - (g->next ? g->assigned_gotno : 0);
2812 hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = max_local;
2813 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *)
2814 elf_hash_table (info)),
2815 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f,
2816 &hsd);
2817
2818 /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
2819 accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols. */
2820 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
2821 BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned long)hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
2822 <= elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount);
2823
2824 /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
2825 table index in the GOT. */
2826 g->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
2827
2828 return TRUE;
2829 }
2830
2831 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
2832 index. Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
2833 index. */
2834
2835 static bfd_boolean
2836 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2837 {
2838 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
2839
2840 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2841 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
2842
2843 /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
2844 at all. */
2845 if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
2846 return TRUE;
2847
2848 /* Global symbols that need GOT entries that are not explicitly
2849 referenced are marked with got offset 2. Those that are
2850 referenced get a 1, and those that don't need GOT entries get
2851 -1. Forced local symbols may also be marked with got offset 1,
2852 but are never given global GOT entries. */
2853 if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
2854 {
2855 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2856
2857 if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
2858 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2859 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
2860 }
2861 else if (h->root.got.offset != 1 || h->forced_local)
2862 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
2863 else
2864 {
2865 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2866
2867 h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
2868 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2869 }
2870
2871 return TRUE;
2872 }
2873
2874 /* If H is a symbol that needs a global GOT entry, but has a dynamic
2875 symbol table index lower than any we've seen to date, record it for
2876 posterity. */
2877
2878 static bfd_boolean
2879 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2880 bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2881 struct mips_got_info *g,
2882 unsigned char tls_flag)
2883 {
2884 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2885
2886 /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
2887 table. */
2888 if (h->dynindx == -1)
2889 {
2890 switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
2891 {
2892 case STV_INTERNAL:
2893 case STV_HIDDEN:
2894 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
2895 break;
2896 }
2897 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
2898 return FALSE;
2899 }
2900
2901 /* Make sure we have a GOT to put this entry into. */
2902 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2903
2904 entry.abfd = abfd;
2905 entry.symndx = -1;
2906 entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2907 entry.tls_type = 0;
2908
2909 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2910 INSERT);
2911
2912 /* If we've already marked this entry as needing GOT space, we don't
2913 need to do it again. */
2914 if (*loc)
2915 {
2916 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2917 return TRUE;
2918 }
2919
2920 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2921
2922 if (! *loc)
2923 return FALSE;
2924
2925 entry.gotidx = -1;
2926 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2927
2928 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2929
2930 if (h->got.offset != MINUS_ONE)
2931 return TRUE;
2932
2933 if (tls_flag == 0)
2934 {
2935 /* By setting this to a value other than -1, we are indicating that
2936 there needs to be a GOT entry for H. Avoid using zero, as the
2937 generic ELF copy_indirect_symbol tests for <= 0. */
2938 h->got.offset = 1;
2939 if (h->forced_local)
2940 g->local_gotno++;
2941 }
2942
2943 return TRUE;
2944 }
2945
2946 /* Reserve space in G for a GOT entry containing the value of symbol
2947 SYMNDX in input bfd ABDF, plus ADDEND. */
2948
2949 static bfd_boolean
2950 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
2951 struct mips_got_info *g,
2952 unsigned char tls_flag)
2953 {
2954 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2955
2956 entry.abfd = abfd;
2957 entry.symndx = symndx;
2958 entry.d.addend = addend;
2959 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2960 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **)
2961 htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, INSERT);
2962
2963 if (*loc)
2964 {
2965 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
2966 {
2967 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2968 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2969 }
2970 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE))
2971 {
2972 g->tls_gotno += 1;
2973 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2974 }
2975 return TRUE;
2976 }
2977
2978 if (tls_flag != 0)
2979 {
2980 entry.gotidx = -1;
2981 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2982 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE)
2983 g->tls_gotno += 1;
2984 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD)
2985 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2986 else if (g->tls_ldm_offset == MINUS_ONE)
2987 {
2988 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_TWO;
2989 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2990 }
2991 }
2992 else
2993 {
2994 entry.gotidx = g->local_gotno++;
2995 entry.tls_type = 0;
2996 }
2997
2998 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2999
3000 if (! *loc)
3001 return FALSE;
3002
3003 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
3004
3005 return TRUE;
3006 }
3007
3008 /* Return the maximum number of GOT page entries required for RANGE. */
3009
3010 static bfd_vma
3011 mips_elf_pages_for_range (const struct mips_got_page_range *range)
3012 {
3013 return (range->max_addend - range->min_addend + 0x1ffff) >> 16;
3014 }
3015
3016 /* Record that ABFD has a page relocation against symbol SYMNDX and
3017 that ADDEND is the addend for that relocation. G is the GOT
3018 information. This function creates an upper bound on the number of
3019 GOT slots required; no attempt is made to combine references to
3020 non-overridable global symbols across multiple input files. */
3021
3022 static bfd_boolean
3023 mips_elf_record_got_page_entry (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_signed_vma addend,
3024 struct mips_got_info *g)
3025 {
3026 struct mips_got_page_entry lookup, *entry;
3027 struct mips_got_page_range **range_ptr, *range;
3028 bfd_vma old_pages, new_pages;
3029 void **loc;
3030
3031 /* Find the mips_got_page_entry hash table entry for this symbol. */
3032 lookup.abfd = abfd;
3033 lookup.symndx = symndx;
3034 loc = htab_find_slot (g->got_page_entries, &lookup, INSERT);
3035 if (loc == NULL)
3036 return FALSE;
3037
3038 /* Create a mips_got_page_entry if this is the first time we've
3039 seen the symbol. */
3040 entry = (struct mips_got_page_entry *) *loc;
3041 if (!entry)
3042 {
3043 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
3044 if (!entry)
3045 return FALSE;
3046
3047 entry->abfd = abfd;
3048 entry->symndx = symndx;
3049 entry->ranges = NULL;
3050 entry->num_pages = 0;
3051 *loc = entry;
3052 }
3053
3054 /* Skip over ranges whose maximum extent cannot share a page entry
3055 with ADDEND. */
3056 range_ptr = &entry->ranges;
3057 while (*range_ptr && addend > (*range_ptr)->max_addend + 0xffff)
3058 range_ptr = &(*range_ptr)->next;
3059
3060 /* If we scanned to the end of the list, or found a range whose
3061 minimum extent cannot share a page entry with ADDEND, create
3062 a new singleton range. */
3063 range = *range_ptr;
3064 if (!range || addend < range->min_addend - 0xffff)
3065 {
3066 range = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*range));
3067 if (!range)
3068 return FALSE;
3069
3070 range->next = *range_ptr;
3071 range->min_addend = addend;
3072 range->max_addend = addend;
3073
3074 *range_ptr = range;
3075 entry->num_pages++;
3076 g->page_gotno++;
3077 return TRUE;
3078 }
3079
3080 /* Remember how many pages the old range contributed. */
3081 old_pages = mips_elf_pages_for_range (range);
3082
3083 /* Update the ranges. */
3084 if (addend < range->min_addend)
3085 range->min_addend = addend;
3086 else if (addend > range->max_addend)
3087 {
3088 if (range->next && addend >= range->next->min_addend - 0xffff)
3089 {
3090 old_pages += mips_elf_pages_for_range (range->next);
3091 range->max_addend = range->next->max_addend;
3092 range->next = range->next->next;
3093 }
3094 else
3095 range->max_addend = addend;
3096 }
3097
3098 /* Record any change in the total estimate. */
3099 new_pages = mips_elf_pages_for_range (range);
3100 if (old_pages != new_pages)
3101 {
3102 entry->num_pages += new_pages - old_pages;
3103 g->page_gotno += new_pages - old_pages;
3104 }
3105
3106 return TRUE;
3107 }
3108 \f
3109 /* Compute the hash value of the bfd in a bfd2got hash entry. */
3110
3111 static hashval_t
3112 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
3113 {
3114 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *entry
3115 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry_;
3116
3117 return entry->bfd->id;
3118 }
3119
3120 /* Check whether two hash entries have the same bfd. */
3121
3122 static int
3123 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
3124 {
3125 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e1
3126 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry1;
3127 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e2
3128 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry2;
3129
3130 return e1->bfd == e2->bfd;
3131 }
3132
3133 /* In a multi-got link, determine the GOT to be used for IBFD. G must
3134 be the master GOT data. */
3135
3136 static struct mips_got_info *
3137 mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
3138 {
3139 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash e, *p;
3140
3141 if (! g->bfd2got)
3142 return g;
3143
3144 e.bfd = ibfd;
3145 p = htab_find (g->bfd2got, &e);
3146 return p ? p->g : NULL;
3147 }
3148
3149 /* Use BFD2GOT to find ABFD's got entry, creating one if none exists.
3150 Return NULL if an error occured. */
3151
3152 static struct mips_got_info *
3153 mips_elf_get_got_for_bfd (struct htab *bfd2got, bfd *output_bfd,
3154 bfd *input_bfd)
3155 {
3156 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash bfdgot_entry, *bfdgot;
3157 struct mips_got_info *g;
3158 void **bfdgotp;
3159
3160 bfdgot_entry.bfd = input_bfd;
3161 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (bfd2got, &bfdgot_entry, INSERT);
3162 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *) *bfdgotp;
3163
3164 if (bfdgot == NULL)
3165 {
3166 bfdgot = ((struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)
3167 bfd_alloc (output_bfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash)));
3168 if (bfdgot == NULL)
3169 return NULL;
3170
3171 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3172
3173 g = ((struct mips_got_info *)
3174 bfd_alloc (output_bfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info)));
3175 if (g == NULL)
3176 return NULL;
3177
3178 bfdgot->bfd = input_bfd;
3179 bfdgot->g = g;
3180
3181 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
3182 g->global_gotno = 0;
3183 g->local_gotno = 0;
3184 g->page_gotno = 0;
3185 g->assigned_gotno = -1;
3186 g->tls_gotno = 0;
3187 g->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3188 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3189 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3190 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3191 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3192 return NULL;
3193
3194 g->got_page_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_entry_hash,
3195 mips_got_page_entry_eq, NULL);
3196 if (g->got_page_entries == NULL)
3197 return NULL;
3198
3199 g->bfd2got = NULL;
3200 g->next = NULL;
3201 }
3202
3203 return bfdgot->g;
3204 }
3205
3206 /* A htab_traverse callback for the entries in the master got.
3207 Create one separate got for each bfd that has entries in the global
3208 got, such that we can tell how many local and global entries each
3209 bfd requires. */
3210
3211 static int
3212 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
3213 {
3214 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3215 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
3216 struct mips_got_info *g;
3217
3218 g = mips_elf_get_got_for_bfd (arg->bfd2got, arg->obfd, entry->abfd);
3219 if (g == NULL)
3220 {
3221 arg->obfd = NULL;
3222 return 0;
3223 }
3224
3225 /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */
3226 entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
3227 if (*entryp != NULL)
3228 return 1;
3229
3230 *entryp = entry;
3231
3232 if (entry->tls_type)
3233 {
3234 if (entry->tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
3235 g->tls_gotno += 2;
3236 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
3237 g->tls_gotno += 1;
3238 }
3239 else if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->forced_local)
3240 ++g->local_gotno;
3241 else
3242 ++g->global_gotno;
3243
3244 return 1;
3245 }
3246
3247 /* A htab_traverse callback for the page entries in the master got.
3248 Associate each page entry with the bfd's got. */
3249
3250 static int
3251 mips_elf_make_got_pages_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
3252 {
3253 struct mips_got_page_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_page_entry *) *entryp;
3254 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *) p;
3255 struct mips_got_info *g;
3256
3257 g = mips_elf_get_got_for_bfd (arg->bfd2got, arg->obfd, entry->abfd);
3258 if (g == NULL)
3259 {
3260 arg->obfd = NULL;
3261 return 0;
3262 }
3263
3264 /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */
3265 entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_page_entries, entry, INSERT);
3266 if (*entryp != NULL)
3267 return 1;
3268
3269 *entryp = entry;
3270 g->page_gotno += entry->num_pages;
3271 return 1;
3272 }
3273
3274 /* Consider merging the got described by BFD2GOT with TO, using the
3275 information given by ARG. Return -1 if this would lead to overflow,
3276 1 if they were merged successfully, and 0 if a merge failed due to
3277 lack of memory. (These values are chosen so that nonnegative return
3278 values can be returned by a htab_traverse callback.) */
3279
3280 static int
3281 mips_elf_merge_got_with (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got,
3282 struct mips_got_info *to,
3283 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg)
3284 {
3285 struct mips_got_info *from = bfd2got->g;
3286 unsigned int estimate;
3287
3288 /* Work out how many page entries we would need for the combined GOT. */
3289 estimate = arg->max_pages;
3290 if (estimate >= from->page_gotno + to->page_gotno)
3291 estimate = from->page_gotno + to->page_gotno;
3292
3293 /* And conservatively estimate how many local, global and TLS entries
3294 would be needed. */
3295 estimate += (from->local_gotno
3296 + from->global_gotno
3297 + from->tls_gotno
3298 + to->local_gotno
3299 + to->global_gotno
3300 + to->tls_gotno);
3301
3302 /* Bail out if the combined GOT might be too big. */
3303 if (estimate > arg->max_count)
3304 return -1;
3305
3306 /* Commit to the merge. Record that TO is now the bfd for this got. */
3307 bfd2got->g = to;
3308
3309 /* Transfer the bfd's got information from FROM to TO. */
3310 htab_traverse (from->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, arg);
3311 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
3312 return 0;
3313
3314 htab_traverse (from->got_page_entries, mips_elf_make_got_pages_per_bfd, arg);
3315 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
3316 return 0;
3317
3318 /* We don't have to worry about releasing memory of the actual
3319 got entries, since they're all in the master got_entries hash
3320 table anyway. */
3321 htab_delete (from->got_entries);
3322 htab_delete (from->got_page_entries);
3323 return 1;
3324 }
3325
3326 /* Attempt to merge gots of different input bfds. Try to use as much
3327 as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
3328 dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
3329 symbols out of the addressable range. Failing the primary got,
3330 attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
3331 and then make make the new got current. */
3332
3333 static int
3334 mips_elf_merge_gots (void **bfd2got_, void *p)
3335 {
3336 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got
3337 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfd2got_;
3338 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
3339 struct mips_got_info *g;
3340 unsigned int estimate;
3341 int result;
3342
3343 g = bfd2got->g;
3344
3345 /* Work out the number of page, local and TLS entries. */
3346 estimate = arg->max_pages;
3347 if (estimate > g->page_gotno)
3348 estimate = g->page_gotno;
3349 estimate += g->local_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
3350
3351 /* We place TLS GOT entries after both locals and globals. The globals
3352 for the primary GOT may overflow the normal GOT size limit, so be
3353 sure not to merge a GOT which requires TLS with the primary GOT in that
3354 case. This doesn't affect non-primary GOTs. */
3355 estimate += (g->tls_gotno > 0 ? arg->global_count : g->global_gotno);
3356
3357 if (estimate <= arg->max_count)
3358 {
3359 /* If we don't have a primary GOT, use it as
3360 a starting point for the primary GOT. */
3361 if (!arg->primary)
3362 {
3363 arg->primary = bfd2got->g;
3364 return 1;
3365 }
3366
3367 /* Try merging with the primary GOT. */
3368 result = mips_elf_merge_got_with (bfd2got, arg->primary, arg);
3369 if (result >= 0)
3370 return result;
3371 }
3372
3373 /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it. */
3374 if (arg->current)
3375 {
3376 result = mips_elf_merge_got_with (bfd2got, arg->current, arg);
3377 if (result >= 0)
3378 return result;
3379 }
3380
3381 /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT. Don't check if it
3382 fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
3383 overflows anyway. */
3384 g->next = arg->current;
3385 arg->current = g;
3386
3387 return 1;
3388 }
3389
3390 /* Set the TLS GOT index for the GOT entry in ENTRYP. ENTRYP's NEXT field
3391 is null iff there is just a single GOT. */
3392
3393 static int
3394 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index (void **entryp, void *p)
3395 {
3396 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3397 struct mips_got_info *g = p;
3398 bfd_vma next_index;
3399 unsigned char tls_type;
3400
3401 /* We're only interested in TLS symbols. */
3402 if (entry->tls_type == 0)
3403 return 1;
3404
3405 next_index = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (entry->abfd) * (long) g->tls_assigned_gotno;
3406
3407 if (entry->symndx == -1 && g->next == NULL)
3408 {
3409 /* A type (3) got entry in the single-GOT case. We use the symbol's
3410 hash table entry to track its index. */
3411 if (entry->d.h->tls_type & GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE)
3412 return 1;
3413 entry->d.h->tls_type |= GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE;
3414 entry->d.h->tls_got_offset = next_index;
3415 tls_type = entry->d.h->tls_type;
3416 }
3417 else
3418 {
3419 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
3420 {
3421 /* There are separate mips_got_entry objects for each input bfd
3422 that requires an LDM entry. Make sure that all LDM entries in
3423 a GOT resolve to the same index. */
3424 if (g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_TWO && g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_ONE)
3425 {
3426 entry->gotidx = g->tls_ldm_offset;
3427 return 1;
3428 }
3429 g->tls_ldm_offset = next_index;
3430 }
3431 entry->gotidx = next_index;
3432 tls_type = entry->tls_type;
3433 }
3434
3435 /* Account for the entries we've just allocated. */
3436 if (tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
3437 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 2;
3438 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
3439 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 1;
3440
3441 return 1;
3442 }
3443
3444 /* If passed a NULL mips_got_info in the argument, set the marker used
3445 to tell whether a global symbol needs a got entry (in the primary
3446 got) to the given VALUE.
3447
3448 If passed a pointer G to a mips_got_info in the argument (it must
3449 not be the primary GOT), compute the offset from the beginning of
3450 the (primary) GOT section to the entry in G corresponding to the
3451 global symbol. G's assigned_gotno must contain the index of the
3452 first available global GOT entry in G. VALUE must contain the size
3453 of a GOT entry in bytes. For each global GOT entry that requires a
3454 dynamic relocation, NEEDED_RELOCS is incremented, and the symbol is
3455 marked as not eligible for lazy resolution through a function
3456 stub. */
3457 static int
3458 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset (void **entryp, void *p)
3459 {
3460 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3461 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *arg
3462 = (struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *)p;
3463 struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
3464
3465 if (g && entry->tls_type != GOT_NORMAL)
3466 arg->needed_relocs +=
3467 mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type,
3468 entry->symndx == -1 ? &entry->d.h->root : NULL);
3469
3470 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1
3471 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1
3472 && !entry->d.h->forced_local
3473 && entry->d.h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL)
3474 {
3475 if (g)
3476 {
3477 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotsym == NULL);
3478
3479 entry->gotidx = arg->value * (long) g->assigned_gotno++;
3480 if (arg->info->shared
3481 || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
3482 && entry->d.h->root.def_dynamic
3483 && !entry->d.h->root.def_regular))
3484 ++arg->needed_relocs;
3485 }
3486 else
3487 entry->d.h->root.got.offset = arg->value;
3488 }
3489
3490 return 1;
3491 }
3492
3493 /* Mark any global symbols referenced in the GOT we are iterating over
3494 as inelligible for lazy resolution stubs. */
3495 static int
3496 mips_elf_set_no_stub (void **entryp, void *p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3497 {
3498 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3499
3500 if (entry->abfd != NULL
3501 && entry->symndx == -1
3502 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1)
3503 entry->d.h->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
3504
3505 return 1;
3506 }
3507
3508 /* Follow indirect and warning hash entries so that each got entry
3509 points to the final symbol definition. P must point to a pointer
3510 to the hash table we're traversing. Since this traversal may
3511 modify the hash table, we set this pointer to NULL to indicate
3512 we've made a potentially-destructive change to the hash table, so
3513 the traversal must be restarted. */
3514 static int
3515 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry (void **entryp, void *p)
3516 {
3517 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3518 htab_t got_entries = *(htab_t *)p;
3519
3520 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3521 {
3522 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = entry->d.h;
3523
3524 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3525 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3526 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3527
3528 if (entry->d.h == h)
3529 return 1;
3530
3531 entry->d.h = h;
3532
3533 /* If we can't find this entry with the new bfd hash, re-insert
3534 it, and get the traversal restarted. */
3535 if (! htab_find (got_entries, entry))
3536 {
3537 htab_clear_slot (got_entries, entryp);
3538 entryp = htab_find_slot (got_entries, entry, INSERT);
3539 if (! *entryp)
3540 *entryp = entry;
3541 /* Abort the traversal, since the whole table may have
3542 moved, and leave it up to the parent to restart the
3543 process. */
3544 *(htab_t *)p = NULL;
3545 return 0;
3546 }
3547 /* We might want to decrement the global_gotno count, but it's
3548 either too early or too late for that at this point. */
3549 }
3550
3551 return 1;
3552 }
3553
3554 /* Turn indirect got entries in a got_entries table into their final
3555 locations. */
3556 static void
3557 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct mips_got_info *g)
3558 {
3559 htab_t got_entries;
3560
3561 do
3562 {
3563 got_entries = g->got_entries;
3564
3565 htab_traverse (got_entries,
3566 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry,
3567 &got_entries);
3568 }
3569 while (got_entries == NULL);
3570 }
3571
3572 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
3573 the primary GOT. */
3574 static bfd_vma
3575 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
3576 {
3577 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3578 return 0;
3579
3580 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
3581 if (! g)
3582 return 0;
3583
3584 BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
3585
3586 g = g->next;
3587
3588 return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno)
3589 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3590 }
3591
3592 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
3593 a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable. */
3594
3595 static bfd_boolean
3596 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3597 struct mips_got_info *g, asection *got,
3598 bfd_size_type pages)
3599 {
3600 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
3601 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
3602 struct mips_got_info *gg;
3603 unsigned int assign;
3604
3605 g->bfd2got = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash,
3606 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq, NULL);
3607 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3608 return FALSE;
3609
3610 got_per_bfd_arg.bfd2got = g->bfd2got;
3611 got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
3612 got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
3613
3614 /* Count how many GOT entries each input bfd requires, creating a
3615 map from bfd to got info while at that. */
3616 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3617 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3618 return FALSE;
3619
3620 /* Also count how many page entries each input bfd requires. */
3621 htab_traverse (g->got_page_entries, mips_elf_make_got_pages_per_bfd,
3622 &got_per_bfd_arg);
3623 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3624 return FALSE;
3625
3626 got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
3627 got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
3628 got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info)
3629 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
3630 - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info));
3631 got_per_bfd_arg.max_pages = pages;
3632 /* The number of globals that will be included in the primary GOT.
3633 See the calls to mips_elf_set_global_got_offset below for more
3634 information. */
3635 got_per_bfd_arg.global_count = g->global_gotno;
3636
3637 /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
3638 don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
3639 to be the primary GOT. */
3640 htab_traverse (g->bfd2got, mips_elf_merge_gots, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3641 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3642 return FALSE;
3643
3644 /* If we do not find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one. */
3645 if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
3646 {
3647 g->next = (struct mips_got_info *)
3648 bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3649 if (g->next == NULL)
3650 return FALSE;
3651
3652 g->next->global_gotsym = NULL;
3653 g->next->global_gotno = 0;
3654 g->next->local_gotno = 0;
3655 g->next->page_gotno = 0;
3656 g->next->tls_gotno = 0;
3657 g->next->assigned_gotno = 0;
3658 g->next->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3659 g->next->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3660 g->next->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3661 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq,
3662 NULL);
3663 if (g->next->got_entries == NULL)
3664 return FALSE;
3665 g->next->got_page_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_entry_hash,
3666 mips_got_page_entry_eq,
3667 NULL);
3668 if (g->next->got_page_entries == NULL)
3669 return FALSE;
3670 g->next->bfd2got = NULL;
3671 }
3672 else
3673 g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
3674 g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
3675
3676 /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT. */
3677 gg = g;
3678 g = g->next;
3679
3680 /* Map the output bfd to the primary got. That's what we're going
3681 to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
3682 didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
3683 We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
3684 list. */
3685 {
3686 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfdgot;
3687 void **bfdgotp;
3688
3689 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
3690 (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
3691
3692 if (bfdgot == NULL)
3693 return FALSE;
3694
3695 bfdgot->bfd = abfd;
3696 bfdgot->g = g;
3697 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (gg->bfd2got, bfdgot, INSERT);
3698
3699 BFD_ASSERT (*bfdgotp == NULL);
3700 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3701 }
3702
3703 /* The IRIX dynamic linker requires every symbol that is referenced
3704 in a dynamic relocation to be present in the primary GOT, so
3705 arrange for them to appear after those that are actually
3706 referenced.
3707
3708 GNU/Linux could very well do without it, but it would slow down
3709 the dynamic linker, since it would have to resolve every dynamic
3710 symbol referenced in other GOTs more than once, without help from
3711 the cache. Also, knowing that every external symbol has a GOT
3712 helps speed up the resolution of local symbols too, so GNU/Linux
3713 follows IRIX's practice.
3714
3715 The number 2 is used by mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f to count
3716 global GOT symbols that are unreferenced in the primary GOT, with
3717 an initial dynamic index computed from gg->assigned_gotno, where
3718 the number of unreferenced global entries in the primary GOT is
3719 preserved. */
3720 if (1)
3721 {
3722 gg->assigned_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
3723 g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
3724 set_got_offset_arg.value = 2;
3725 }
3726 else
3727 {
3728 /* This could be used for dynamic linkers that don't optimize
3729 symbol resolution while applying relocations so as to use
3730 primary GOT entries or assuming the symbol is locally-defined.
3731 With this code, we assign lower dynamic indices to global
3732 symbols that are not referenced in the primary GOT, so that
3733 their entries can be omitted. */
3734 gg->assigned_gotno = 0;
3735 set_got_offset_arg.value = -1;
3736 }
3737
3738 /* Reorder dynamic symbols as described above (which behavior
3739 depends on the setting of VALUE). */
3740 set_got_offset_arg.g = NULL;
3741 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3742 &set_got_offset_arg);
3743 set_got_offset_arg.value = 1;
3744 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3745 &set_got_offset_arg);
3746 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
3747 return FALSE;
3748
3749 /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
3750 [assigned_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
3751 entries in each GOT. We can then compute the end of a GOT by
3752 adding local_gotno to global_gotno. We reverse the list and make
3753 it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
3754 beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor. To
3755 avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
3756 assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
3757 we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
3758 global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
3759 offset of the primary GOT is zero. Remember that the primary GOT
3760 will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
3761 points back to the master GOT. */
3762 gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
3763 gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
3764 gg->tls_gotno = 0;
3765 assign = 0;
3766 gg->next = gg;
3767
3768 do
3769 {
3770 struct mips_got_info *gn;
3771
3772 assign += MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3773 g->assigned_gotno = assign;
3774 g->local_gotno += assign;
3775 g->local_gotno += (pages < g->page_gotno ? pages : g->page_gotno);
3776 assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
3777
3778 /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
3779 list that gg points to. g->next is guaranteed to be nonnull after
3780 this operation, as required by mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
3781 gn = g->next;
3782 g->next = gg->next;
3783 gg->next = g;
3784
3785 /* Set up any TLS entries. We always place the TLS entries after
3786 all non-TLS entries. */
3787 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
3788 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
3789
3790 /* Move onto the next GOT. It will be a secondary GOT if nonull. */
3791 g = gn;
3792
3793 /* Mark global symbols in every non-primary GOT as ineligible for
3794 stubs. */
3795 if (g)
3796 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_no_stub, NULL);
3797 }
3798 while (g);
3799
3800 got->size = (gg->next->local_gotno
3801 + gg->next->global_gotno
3802 + gg->next->tls_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3803
3804 return TRUE;
3805 }
3806
3807 \f
3808 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
3809 RELOCATION. RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table. */
3810
3811 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
3812 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
3813 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3814 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
3815 {
3816 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info);
3817
3818 while (relocation < relend)
3819 {
3820 if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type
3821 && ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_symndx)
3822 return relocation;
3823
3824 ++relocation;
3825 }
3826
3827 /* We didn't find it. */
3828 return NULL;
3829 }
3830
3831 /* Return whether a relocation is against a local symbol. */
3832
3833 static bfd_boolean
3834 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
3835 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3836 asection **local_sections,
3837 bfd_boolean check_forced)
3838 {
3839 unsigned long r_symndx;
3840 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3841 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3842 size_t extsymoff;
3843
3844 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3845 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3846 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3847
3848 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
3849 return TRUE;
3850 if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
3851 return TRUE;
3852
3853 if (check_forced)
3854 {
3855 /* Look up the hash table to check whether the symbol
3856 was forced local. */
3857 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3858 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
3859 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
3860 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3861 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3862 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3863 if (h->root.forced_local)
3864 return TRUE;
3865 }
3866
3867 return FALSE;
3868 }
3869 \f
3870 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS. */
3871
3872 bfd_vma
3873 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3874 {
3875 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
3876 /* VALUE is negative. */
3877 value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
3878
3879 return value;
3880 }
3881
3882 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
3883 range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
3884 BITS. */
3885
3886 static bfd_boolean
3887 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3888 {
3889 bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
3890
3891 if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
3892 /* The value is too big. */
3893 return TRUE;
3894 else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
3895 /* The value is too small. */
3896 return TRUE;
3897
3898 /* All is well. */
3899 return FALSE;
3900 }
3901
3902 /* Calculate the %high function. */
3903
3904 static bfd_vma
3905 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
3906 {
3907 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
3908 }
3909
3910 /* Calculate the %higher function. */
3911
3912 static bfd_vma
3913 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3914 {
3915 #ifdef BFD64
3916 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
3917 #else
3918 abort ();
3919 return MINUS_ONE;
3920 #endif
3921 }
3922
3923 /* Calculate the %highest function. */
3924
3925 static bfd_vma
3926 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3927 {
3928 #ifdef BFD64
3929 return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
3930 #else
3931 abort ();
3932 return MINUS_ONE;
3933 #endif
3934 }
3935 \f
3936 /* Create the .compact_rel section. */
3937
3938 static bfd_boolean
3939 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
3940 (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3941 {
3942 flagword flags;
3943 register asection *s;
3944
3945 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
3946 {
3947 flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
3948 | SEC_READONLY);
3949
3950 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".compact_rel", flags);
3951 if (s == NULL
3952 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
3953 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
3954 return FALSE;
3955
3956 s->size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
3957 }
3958
3959 return TRUE;
3960 }
3961
3962 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table. */
3963
3964 static bfd_boolean
3965 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3966 bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)
3967 {
3968 flagword flags;
3969 register asection *s;
3970 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3971 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
3972 struct mips_got_info *g;
3973 bfd_size_type amt;
3974 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3975
3976 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3977
3978 /* This function may be called more than once. */
3979 s = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
3980 if (s)
3981 {
3982 if (! maybe_exclude)
3983 s->flags &= ~SEC_EXCLUDE;
3984 return TRUE;
3985 }
3986
3987 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3988 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3989
3990 if (maybe_exclude)
3991 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
3992
3993 /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
3994 in the function stub generation and in the linker script. */
3995 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
3996 if (s == NULL
3997 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
3998 return FALSE;
3999
4000 /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. We don't do this in the
4001 linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
4002 are not creating a global offset table. */
4003 bh = NULL;
4004 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
4005 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
4006 0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
4007 return FALSE;
4008
4009 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
4010 h->non_elf = 0;
4011 h->def_regular = 1;
4012 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
4013 elf_hash_table (info)->hgot = h;
4014
4015 if (info->shared
4016 && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
4017 return FALSE;
4018
4019 amt = sizeof (struct mips_got_info);
4020 g = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4021 if (g == NULL)
4022 return FALSE;
4023 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
4024 g->global_gotno = 0;
4025 g->tls_gotno = 0;
4026 g->local_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
4027 g->page_gotno = 0;
4028 g->assigned_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
4029 g->bfd2got = NULL;
4030 g->next = NULL;
4031 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
4032 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
4033 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
4034 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
4035 return FALSE;
4036 g->got_page_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_entry_hash,
4037 mips_got_page_entry_eq, NULL);
4038 if (g->got_page_entries == NULL)
4039 return FALSE;
4040 mips_elf_section_data (s)->u.got_info = g;
4041 mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
4042 |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
4043
4044 /* VxWorks also needs a .got.plt section. */
4045 if (htab->is_vxworks)
4046 {
4047 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got.plt",
4048 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4049 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4050 if (s == NULL || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
4051 return FALSE;
4052
4053 htab->sgotplt = s;
4054 }
4055 return TRUE;
4056 }
4057 \f
4058 /* Return true if H refers to the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ or
4059 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols. These symbols are only special for
4060 shared objects; they are not used in executables. */
4061
4062 static bfd_boolean
4063 is_gott_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4064 {
4065 return (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->is_vxworks
4066 && info->shared
4067 && (strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_BASE__") == 0
4068 || strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_INDEX__") == 0));
4069 }
4070 \f
4071 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
4072 the INPUT_BFD). The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
4073 RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
4074
4075 The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
4076 REQUIRE_JALXP indicates whether or not the opcode used with this
4077 relocation must be JALX.
4078
4079 This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
4080 further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
4081 something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
4082 overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success. */
4083
4084 static bfd_reloc_status_type
4085 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
4086 asection *input_section,
4087 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4088 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4089 bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
4090 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
4091 asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
4092 const char **namep, bfd_boolean *require_jalxp,
4093 bfd_boolean save_addend)
4094 {
4095 /* The eventual value we will return. */
4096 bfd_vma value;
4097 /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
4098 occurring. */
4099 bfd_vma symbol = 0;
4100 /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
4101 shared object file being produced. */
4102 bfd_vma gp = MINUS_ONE;
4103 /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
4104 relocated. */
4105 bfd_vma p;
4106 /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object. */
4107 bfd_vma gp0 = MINUS_ONE;
4108 /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
4109 the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
4110 during execution. */
4111 bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
4112 /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
4113 located. */
4114 asection *sec = NULL;
4115 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4116 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
4117 symbol. */
4118 bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
4119 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp". */
4120 bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
4121 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is
4122 "__gnu_local_gp". */
4123 bfd_boolean gnu_local_gp_p = FALSE;
4124 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4125 size_t extsymoff;
4126 unsigned long r_symndx;
4127 int r_type;
4128 /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
4129 relocation value. */
4130 bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
4131 /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function. */
4132 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
4133 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4134 bfd *dynobj;
4135
4136 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4137 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4138
4139 /* Parse the relocation. */
4140 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4141 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4142 p = (input_section->output_section->vma
4143 + input_section->output_offset
4144 + relocation->r_offset);
4145
4146 /* Assume that there will be no overflow. */
4147 overflowed_p = FALSE;
4148
4149 /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
4150 used in the array of hash table entries. */
4151 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
4152 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4153 local_sections, FALSE);
4154 was_local_p = local_p;
4155 if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
4156 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
4157 else
4158 {
4159 /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
4160 must come before globals. */
4161 extsymoff = 0;
4162 }
4163
4164 /* Figure out the value of the symbol. */
4165 if (local_p)
4166 {
4167 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4168
4169 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
4170 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
4171
4172 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4173 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION
4174 || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
4175 symbol += sym->st_value;
4176 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
4177 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
4178 {
4179 addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
4180 addend -= symbol;
4181 addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4182 }
4183
4184 /* MIPS16 text labels should be treated as odd. */
4185 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
4186 ++symbol;
4187
4188 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
4189 *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
4190 symtab_hdr->sh_link,
4191 sym->st_name);
4192 if (*namep == '\0')
4193 *namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
4194
4195 target_is_16_bit_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other);
4196 }
4197 else
4198 {
4199 /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ? */
4200
4201 /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table. */
4202 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
4203 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
4204 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
4205 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4206 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4207 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
4208
4209 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
4210 *namep = h->root.root.root.string;
4211
4212 /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol. Note that such a
4213 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
4214 if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
4215 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
4216 {
4217 /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
4218 R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations. */
4219 if (r_type != R_MIPS_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS_LO16
4220 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
4221 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
4222
4223 gp_disp_p = TRUE;
4224 }
4225 /* See if this is the special _gp symbol. Note that such a
4226 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
4227 else if (strcmp (*namep, "__gnu_local_gp") == 0)
4228 gnu_local_gp_p = TRUE;
4229
4230
4231 /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address. Note that
4232 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
4233 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
4234 its defined. */
4235 else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4236 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4237 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
4238 {
4239 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
4240 if (sec->output_section)
4241 symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
4242 + sec->output_section->vma
4243 + sec->output_offset);
4244 else
4245 symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
4246 }
4247 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4248 /* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
4249 it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
4250 and check to see if they exist by looking at their
4251 addresses. */
4252 symbol = 0;
4253 else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
4254 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
4255 symbol = 0;
4256 else if (strcmp (*namep, SGI_COMPAT (input_bfd)
4257 ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
4258 {
4259 /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
4260 _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
4261 in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
4262 Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
4263 FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
4264 somehow as well. */
4265 BFD_ASSERT (! info->shared);
4266 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
4267 symbol = 0;
4268 }
4269 else if (ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->root.other))
4270 {
4271 /* This is an optional symbol - an Irix specific extension to the
4272 ELF spec. Ignore it for now.
4273 XXX - FIXME - there is more to the spec for OPTIONAL symbols
4274 than simply ignoring them, but we do not handle this for now.
4275 For information see the "64-bit ELF Object File Specification"
4276 which is available from here:
4277 http://techpubs.sgi.com/library/manuals/4000/007-4658-001/pdf/007-4658-001.pdf */
4278 symbol = 0;
4279 }
4280 else
4281 {
4282 if (! ((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
4283 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
4284 input_section, relocation->r_offset,
4285 (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
4286 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other))))
4287 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
4288 symbol = 0;
4289 }
4290
4291 target_is_16_bit_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other);
4292 }
4293
4294 /* If this is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function with a stub, we
4295 need to redirect the call to the stub, unless we're already *in*
4296 a stub. */
4297 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
4298 && ((h != NULL && h->fn_stub != NULL)
4299 || (local_p
4300 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
4301 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
4302 && !mips16_stub_section_p (input_bfd, input_section))
4303 {
4304 /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function. We should
4305 have already noticed that we were going to need the
4306 stub. */
4307 if (local_p)
4308 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
4309 else
4310 {
4311 BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
4312 sec = h->fn_stub;
4313 }
4314
4315 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4316 /* The target is 16-bit, but the stub isn't. */
4317 target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
4318 }
4319 /* If this is a 16-bit call to a 32- or 64-bit function with a stub, we
4320 need to redirect the call to the stub. */
4321 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
4322 && ((h != NULL && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL))
4323 || (local_p
4324 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs != NULL
4325 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
4326 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
4327 {
4328 if (local_p)
4329 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx];
4330 else
4331 {
4332 /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
4333 out which one to use by checking which one appears in the input
4334 file. */
4335 if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
4336 {
4337 asection *o;
4338
4339 sec = NULL;
4340 for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
4341 {
4342 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o)))
4343 {
4344 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
4345 break;
4346 }
4347 }
4348 if (sec == NULL)
4349 sec = h->call_stub;
4350 }
4351 else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
4352 sec = h->call_stub;
4353 else
4354 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
4355 }
4356
4357 BFD_ASSERT (sec->size > 0);
4358 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4359 }
4360
4361 /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
4362 special jalx instruction. */
4363 *require_jalxp = (!info->relocatable
4364 && (((r_type == R_MIPS16_26) && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
4365 || ((r_type == R_MIPS_26) && target_is_16_bit_code_p)));
4366
4367 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4368 local_sections, TRUE);
4369
4370 /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, or the GP value,
4371 and we're going to need it, get it now. */
4372 switch (r_type)
4373 {
4374 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
4375 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
4376 /* We need to decay to GOT_DISP/addend if the symbol doesn't
4377 bind locally. */
4378 local_p = local_p || _bfd_elf_symbol_refs_local_p (&h->root, info, 1);
4379 if (local_p || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_OFST)
4380 break;
4381 /* Fall through. */
4382
4383 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
4384 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
4385 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
4386 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
4387 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
4388 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
4389 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
4390 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
4391 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
4392 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
4393 /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located. */
4394 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
4395 {
4396 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4397 0, 0, NULL, r_type);
4398 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
4399 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4400 }
4401 else if (!local_p)
4402 {
4403 /* On VxWorks, CALL relocations should refer to the .got.plt
4404 entry, which is initialized to point at the PLT stub. */
4405 if (htab->is_vxworks
4406 && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_HI16
4407 || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
4408 || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16))
4409 {
4410 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
4411 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.needs_plt);
4412 g = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, &h->root);
4413 }
4414 else
4415 {
4416 /* GOT_PAGE may take a non-zero addend, that is ignored in a
4417 GOT_PAGE relocation that decays to GOT_DISP because the
4418 symbol turns out to be global. The addend is then added
4419 as GOT_OFST. */
4420 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
4421 g = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, input_bfd,
4422 &h->root, r_type, info);
4423 if (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL
4424 && (! elf_hash_table(info)->dynamic_sections_created
4425 || (info->shared
4426 && (info->symbolic || h->root.forced_local)
4427 && h->root.def_regular)))
4428 {
4429 /* This is a static link or a -Bsymbolic link. The
4430 symbol is defined locally, or was forced to be local.
4431 We must initialize this entry in the GOT. */
4432 asection *sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
4433 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (dynobj, symbol, sgot->contents + g);
4434 }
4435 }
4436 }
4437 else if (!htab->is_vxworks
4438 && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)))
4439 /* The calculation below does not involve "g". */
4440 break;
4441 else
4442 {
4443 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4444 symbol + addend, r_symndx, h, r_type);
4445 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
4446 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4447 }
4448
4449 /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets. */
4450 g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, g);
4451 break;
4452
4453 case R_MIPS_HI16:
4454 case R_MIPS_LO16:
4455 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
4456 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
4457 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
4458 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
4459 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
4460 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
4461 gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
4462 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
4463 if (dynobj)
4464 gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd, mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL),
4465 input_bfd);
4466 break;
4467
4468 default:
4469 break;
4470 }
4471
4472 if (gnu_local_gp_p)
4473 symbol = gp;
4474
4475 /* Relocations against the VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__
4476 symbols are resolved by the loader. Add them to .rela.dyn. */
4477 if (h != NULL && is_gott_symbol (info, &h->root))
4478 {
4479 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
4480 bfd_byte *loc;
4481 asection *s;
4482
4483 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4484 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4485
4486 outrel.r_offset = (input_section->output_section->vma
4487 + input_section->output_offset
4488 + relocation->r_offset);
4489 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->root.dynindx, r_type);
4490 outrel.r_addend = addend;
4491 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
4492
4493 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
4494 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
4495 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
4496 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
4497 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
4498
4499 *valuep = 0;
4500 return bfd_reloc_ok;
4501 }
4502
4503 /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed. */
4504 switch (r_type)
4505 {
4506 case R_MIPS_NONE:
4507 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4508
4509 case R_MIPS_16:
4510 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
4511 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4512 break;
4513
4514 case R_MIPS_32:
4515 case R_MIPS_REL32:
4516 case R_MIPS_64:
4517 if ((info->shared
4518 || (!htab->is_vxworks
4519 && htab->root.dynamic_sections_created
4520 && h != NULL
4521 && h->root.def_dynamic
4522 && !h->root.def_regular))
4523 && r_symndx != 0
4524 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4525 {
4526 /* If we're creating a shared library, or this relocation is
4527 against a symbol in a shared library, then we can't know
4528 where the symbol will end up. So, we create a relocation
4529 record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
4530 linker.
4531
4532 In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
4533 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
4534 no need to add a dynamic relocation here. */
4535 value = addend;
4536 if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
4537 info,
4538 relocation,
4539 h,
4540 sec,
4541 symbol,
4542 &value,
4543 input_section))
4544 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
4545 }
4546 else
4547 {
4548 if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4549 value = symbol + addend;
4550 else
4551 value = addend;
4552 }
4553 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4554 break;
4555
4556 case R_MIPS_PC32:
4557 value = symbol + addend - p;
4558 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4559 break;
4560
4561 case R_MIPS16_26:
4562 /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
4563 R_MIPS_26. It's only the storage of the relocated field into
4564 the output file that's different. That's handled in
4565 mips_elf_perform_relocation. So, we just fall through to the
4566 R_MIPS_26 case here. */
4567 case R_MIPS_26:
4568 if (local_p)
4569 value = ((addend | ((p + 4) & 0xf0000000)) + symbol) >> 2;
4570 else
4571 {
4572 value = (_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28) + symbol) >> 2;
4573 if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4574 overflowed_p = (value >> 26) != ((p + 4) >> 28);
4575 }
4576 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4577 break;
4578
4579 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
4580 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - dtprel_base (info))
4581 & howto->dst_mask);
4582 break;
4583
4584 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
4585 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
4586 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
4587 value = (symbol + addend - dtprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4588 break;
4589
4590 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
4591 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - tprel_base (info))
4592 & howto->dst_mask);
4593 break;
4594
4595 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
4596 value = (symbol + addend - tprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4597 break;
4598
4599 case R_MIPS_HI16:
4600 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
4601 if (!gp_disp_p)
4602 {
4603 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
4604 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4605 }
4606 else
4607 {
4608 /* For MIPS16 ABI code we generate this sequence
4609 0: li $v0,%hi(_gp_disp)
4610 4: addiupc $v1,%lo(_gp_disp)
4611 8: sll $v0,16
4612 12: addu $v0,$v1
4613 14: move $gp,$v0
4614 So the offsets of hi and lo relocs are the same, but the
4615 $pc is four higher than $t9 would be, so reduce
4616 both reloc addends by 4. */
4617 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
4618 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p - 4);
4619 else
4620 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
4621 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4622 }
4623 break;
4624
4625 case R_MIPS_LO16:
4626 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
4627 if (!gp_disp_p)
4628 value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
4629 else
4630 {
4631 /* See the comment for R_MIPS16_HI16 above for the reason
4632 for this conditional. */
4633 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16)
4634 value = addend + gp - p;
4635 else
4636 value = addend + gp - p + 4;
4637 /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
4638 for overflow. But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
4639 _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
4640 pseudo-op. It generates code that normally looks like
4641 this:
4642
4643 lui $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
4644 addiu $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
4645 addu $gp,$gp,$t9
4646
4647 Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
4648 as required by the MIPS ELF ABI. The R_MIPS_LO16
4649 relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
4650 R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
4651 Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
4652 not check for overflow here. */
4653 }
4654 break;
4655
4656 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
4657 /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
4658 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16. In the long run, we should merge
4659 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
4660 here. */
4661
4662 /* Fall through. */
4663
4664 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
4665 /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
4666 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
4667 order. We don't need to do anything special here; the
4668 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation. */
4669 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
4670 /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
4671 instruction. If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
4672 otherwise we may lose significant bits. */
4673 if (howto->partial_inplace)
4674 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
4675 value = symbol + addend - gp;
4676 /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
4677 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
4678 for that now. Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
4679 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
4680 to them before. */
4681 if (was_local_p)
4682 value += gp0;
4683 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4684 break;
4685
4686 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
4687 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
4688 /* VxWorks does not have separate local and global semantics for
4689 R_MIPS_GOT16; every relocation evaluates to "G". */
4690 if (!htab->is_vxworks && local_p)
4691 {
4692 bfd_boolean forced;
4693
4694 forced = ! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4695 local_sections, FALSE);
4696 value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4697 symbol + addend, forced);
4698 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4699 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4700 value
4701 = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, value);
4702 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4703 break;
4704 }
4705
4706 /* Fall through. */
4707
4708 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
4709 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
4710 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
4711 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
4712 got_disp:
4713 value = g;
4714 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4715 break;
4716
4717 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
4718 value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
4719 if (!save_addend)
4720 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4721 break;
4722
4723 case R_MIPS_PC16:
4724 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
4725 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18) - p;
4726 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
4727 value >>= howto->rightshift;
4728 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4729 break;
4730
4731 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
4732 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
4733 /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
4734 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
4735 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub. */
4736 value = g;
4737 value = mips_elf_high (value);
4738 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4739 break;
4740
4741 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
4742 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
4743 value = g & howto->dst_mask;
4744 break;
4745
4746 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
4747 /* GOT_PAGE relocations that reference non-local symbols decay
4748 to GOT_DISP. The corresponding GOT_OFST relocation decays to
4749 0. */
4750 if (! local_p)
4751 goto got_disp;
4752 value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
4753 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4754 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4755 value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, value);
4756 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4757 break;
4758
4759 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
4760 if (local_p)
4761 mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
4762 else
4763 value = addend;
4764 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4765 break;
4766
4767 case R_MIPS_SUB:
4768 value = symbol - addend;
4769 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4770 break;
4771
4772 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
4773 value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
4774 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4775 break;
4776
4777 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
4778 value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
4779 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4780 break;
4781
4782 case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
4783 value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
4784 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4785 break;
4786
4787 case R_MIPS_JALR:
4788 /* This relocation is only a hint. In some cases, we optimize
4789 it into a bal instruction. But we don't try to optimize
4790 branches to the PLT; that will wind up wasting time. */
4791 if (h != NULL && h->root.plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
4792 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4793 value = symbol + addend;
4794 break;
4795
4796 case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
4797 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4798 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
4799 /* We don't do anything with these at present. */
4800 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4801
4802 default:
4803 /* An unrecognized relocation type. */
4804 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
4805 }
4806
4807 /* Store the VALUE for our caller. */
4808 *valuep = value;
4809 return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
4810 }
4811
4812 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION. */
4813
4814 static bfd_vma
4815 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
4816 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4817 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
4818 {
4819 bfd_vma x;
4820 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4821
4822 /* Obtain the bytes. */
4823 x = bfd_get ((8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto)), input_bfd, location);
4824
4825 return x;
4826 }
4827
4828 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
4829 VALUE. Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
4830 appropriate position. The SECTION is the section to which the
4831 relocation applies. If REQUIRE_JALX is TRUE, then the opcode used
4832 for the relocation must be either JAL or JALX, and it is
4833 unconditionally converted to JALX.
4834
4835 Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong. */
4836
4837 static bfd_boolean
4838 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4839 reloc_howto_type *howto,
4840 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4841 bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
4842 asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
4843 bfd_boolean require_jalx)
4844 {
4845 bfd_vma x;
4846 bfd_byte *location;
4847 int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4848
4849 /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring. */
4850 location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4851
4852 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
4853
4854 /* Obtain the current value. */
4855 x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
4856
4857 /* Clear the field we are setting. */
4858 x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
4859
4860 /* Set the field. */
4861 x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
4862
4863 /* If required, turn JAL into JALX. */
4864 if (require_jalx)
4865 {
4866 bfd_boolean ok;
4867 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
4868 bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
4869
4870 /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX. */
4871 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
4872 {
4873 ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
4874 jalx_opcode = 0x7;
4875 }
4876 else
4877 {
4878 ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
4879 jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
4880 }
4881
4882 /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem. */
4883 if (!ok)
4884 {
4885 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4886 (_("%B: %A+0x%lx: jump to stub routine which is not jal"),
4887 input_bfd,
4888 input_section,
4889 (unsigned long) relocation->r_offset);
4890 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4891 return FALSE;
4892 }
4893
4894 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */
4895 x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
4896 }
4897
4898 /* On the RM9000, bal is faster than jal, because bal uses branch
4899 prediction hardware. If we are linking for the RM9000, and we
4900 see jal, and bal fits, use it instead. Note that this
4901 transformation should be safe for all architectures. */
4902 if (bfd_get_mach (input_bfd) == bfd_mach_mips9000
4903 && !info->relocatable
4904 && !require_jalx
4905 && ((r_type == R_MIPS_26 && (x >> 26) == 0x3) /* jal addr */
4906 || (r_type == R_MIPS_JALR && x == 0x0320f809))) /* jalr t9 */
4907 {
4908 bfd_vma addr;
4909 bfd_vma dest;
4910 bfd_signed_vma off;
4911
4912 addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
4913 + input_section->output_offset
4914 + relocation->r_offset
4915 + 4);
4916 if (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
4917 dest = (value << 2) | ((addr >> 28) << 28);
4918 else
4919 dest = value;
4920 off = dest - addr;
4921 if (off <= 0x1ffff && off >= -0x20000)
4922 x = 0x04110000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* bal addr */
4923 }
4924
4925 /* Put the value into the output. */
4926 bfd_put (8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto), input_bfd, x, location);
4927
4928 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, !info->relocatable,
4929 location);
4930
4931 return TRUE;
4932 }
4933
4934 /* Returns TRUE if SECTION is a MIPS16 stub section. */
4935
4936 static bfd_boolean
4937 mips16_stub_section_p (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section)
4938 {
4939 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, section);
4940
4941 return FN_STUB_P (name) || CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name);
4942 }
4943 \f
4944 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel(a).dyn section in ABFD. */
4945
4946 static void
4947 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4948 unsigned int n)
4949 {
4950 asection *s;
4951 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4952
4953 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4954 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4955 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4956
4957 if (htab->is_vxworks)
4958 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (abfd);
4959 else
4960 {
4961 if (s->size == 0)
4962 {
4963 /* Make room for a null element. */
4964 s->size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4965 ++s->reloc_count;
4966 }
4967 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4968 }
4969 }
4970
4971 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve. REL
4972 is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
4973 dynamic relocation. The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
4974 caller should store the result in place of the original addend. */
4975
4976 static bfd_boolean
4977 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
4978 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4979 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4980 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4981 asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
4982 bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
4983 {
4984 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
4985 asection *sreloc;
4986 bfd *dynobj;
4987 int r_type;
4988 long indx;
4989 bfd_boolean defined_p;
4990 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4991
4992 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4993 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
4994 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4995 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4996 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
4997 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
4998 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
4999 < sreloc->size);
5000
5001 outrel[0].r_offset =
5002 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
5003 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
5004 {
5005 outrel[1].r_offset =
5006 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
5007 outrel[2].r_offset =
5008 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
5009 }
5010
5011 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_ONE)
5012 /* The relocation field has been deleted. */
5013 return TRUE;
5014
5015 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_TWO)
5016 {
5017 /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
5018 some sort. Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
5019 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value. */
5020 *addendp += symbol;
5021 return TRUE;
5022 }
5023
5024 /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
5025 in the relocation. */
5026 if (h != NULL
5027 && (!h->root.def_regular
5028 || (info->shared && !info->symbolic && !h->root.forced_local)))
5029 {
5030 indx = h->root.dynindx;
5031 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
5032 defined_p = h->root.def_regular;
5033 else
5034 /* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
5035 relocation field. It therefore treats relocs against
5036 defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
5037 undefined symbols. */
5038 defined_p = FALSE;
5039 }
5040 else
5041 {
5042 if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
5043 indx = 0;
5044 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
5045 {
5046 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5047 return FALSE;
5048 }
5049 else
5050 {
5051 indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
5052 if (indx == 0)
5053 {
5054 asection *osec = htab->root.text_index_section;
5055 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
5056 }
5057 if (indx == 0)
5058 abort ();
5059 }
5060
5061 /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
5062 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
5063 relocation. We want to avoid generating relocations to
5064 local symbols because we used to generate them
5065 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
5066 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols. In
5067 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
5068 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
5069 section-relative relocations. It's not like they're
5070 useful, after all. This should be a bit more efficient
5071 as well. */
5072 /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
5073 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
5074 a symbol value of 0. Irix rld honors this, so relocations
5075 against STN_UNDEF have no effect. */
5076 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
5077 indx = 0;
5078 defined_p = TRUE;
5079 }
5080
5081 /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
5082 this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
5083 adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
5084 Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker. */
5085 if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
5086 *addendp += symbol;
5087
5088 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5089 /* VxWorks uses non-relative relocations for this. */
5090 outrel[0].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_MIPS_32);
5091 else
5092 /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
5093 know where the shared library will wind up at load-time. */
5094 outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
5095 R_MIPS_REL32);
5096
5097 /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
5098 generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
5099 _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
5100 a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
5101 However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
5102 loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
5103 artificial relocations. If this turns out to not be true,
5104 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
5105 as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
5106 invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
5107 additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
5108 NULL symbol before this relocation record. */
5109 outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
5110 ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
5111 ? R_MIPS_64
5112 : R_MIPS_NONE);
5113 outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
5114
5115 /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
5116 correct location in the output file. */
5117 outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
5118 + input_section->output_offset);
5119 outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
5120 + input_section->output_offset);
5121 outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
5122 + input_section->output_offset);
5123
5124 /* Put the relocation back out. We have to use the special
5125 relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
5126 relocation format is non-standard. */
5127 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
5128 {
5129 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
5130 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
5131 (sreloc->contents
5132 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
5133 }
5134 else if (htab->is_vxworks)
5135 {
5136 /* VxWorks uses RELA rather than REL dynamic relocations. */
5137 outrel[0].r_addend = *addendp;
5138 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out
5139 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
5140 (sreloc->contents
5141 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
5142 }
5143 else
5144 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
5145 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
5146 (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
5147
5148 /* We've now added another relocation. */
5149 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
5150
5151 /* Make sure the output section is writable. The dynamic linker
5152 will be writing to it. */
5153 elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
5154 |= SHF_WRITE;
5155
5156 /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info. */
5157 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
5158 {
5159 asection *scpt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
5160 bfd_byte *cr;
5161
5162 if (scpt)
5163 {
5164 Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
5165
5166 mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
5167 cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
5168 + input_section->output_section->vma
5169 + input_section->output_offset);
5170 if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
5171 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
5172 else
5173 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
5174 mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
5175 cptrel.konst = *addendp;
5176
5177 cr = (scpt->contents
5178 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
5179 mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr (cptrel, 0);
5180 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
5181 ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
5182 + scpt->reloc_count));
5183 ++scpt->reloc_count;
5184 }
5185 }
5186
5187 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
5188 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
5189 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
5190 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
5191 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5192
5193 return TRUE;
5194 }
5195 \f
5196 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value. */
5197
5198 unsigned long
5199 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
5200 {
5201 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
5202 {
5203 case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
5204 return bfd_mach_mips3900;
5205
5206 case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
5207 return bfd_mach_mips4010;
5208
5209 case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
5210 return bfd_mach_mips4100;
5211
5212 case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
5213 return bfd_mach_mips4111;
5214
5215 case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
5216 return bfd_mach_mips4120;
5217
5218 case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
5219 return bfd_mach_mips4650;
5220
5221 case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
5222 return bfd_mach_mips5400;
5223
5224 case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
5225 return bfd_mach_mips5500;
5226
5227 case E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
5228 return bfd_mach_mips9000;
5229
5230 case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
5231 return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
5232
5233 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS2E:
5234 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e;
5235
5236 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS2F:
5237 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f;
5238
5239 case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON:
5240 return bfd_mach_mips_octeon;
5241
5242 default:
5243 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
5244 {
5245 default:
5246 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
5247 return bfd_mach_mips3000;
5248
5249 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
5250 return bfd_mach_mips6000;
5251
5252 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
5253 return bfd_mach_mips4000;
5254
5255 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
5256 return bfd_mach_mips8000;
5257
5258 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
5259 return bfd_mach_mips5;
5260
5261 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
5262 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
5263
5264 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
5265 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
5266
5267 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
5268 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
5269
5270 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
5271 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
5272 }
5273 }
5274
5275 return 0;
5276 }
5277
5278 /* Return printable name for ABI. */
5279
5280 static INLINE char *
5281 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
5282 {
5283 flagword flags;
5284
5285 flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
5286 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
5287 {
5288 case 0:
5289 if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
5290 return "N32";
5291 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
5292 return "64";
5293 else
5294 return "none";
5295 case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
5296 return "O32";
5297 case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
5298 return "O64";
5299 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
5300 return "EABI32";
5301 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
5302 return "EABI64";
5303 default:
5304 return "unknown abi";
5305 }
5306 }
5307 \f
5308 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections. One is the usual one, and the
5309 other is for small objects. All the small objects are kept
5310 together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
5311 faster assembler code. This is what we use for the small common
5312 section. This approach is copied from ecoff.c. */
5313 static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
5314 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5315 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
5316
5317 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
5318 allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
5319 definition in a shared library. */
5320 static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
5321 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5322 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
5323
5324 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use.
5325 This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
5326
5327 void
5328 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
5329 {
5330 elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
5331
5332 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
5333 switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
5334 {
5335 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
5336 /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
5337 It is an allocated common section. The dynamic linker can
5338 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
5339 library, or it can just leave them here. For our purposes,
5340 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section. */
5341 if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
5342 {
5343 /* Initialize the acommon section. */
5344 mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
5345 mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
5346 mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5347 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5348 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
5349 mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
5350 mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
5351 mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5352 mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5353 }
5354 asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5355 break;
5356
5357 case SHN_COMMON:
5358 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
5359 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5. */
5360 if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
5361 || ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_TLS
5362 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
5363 break;
5364 /* Fall through. */
5365 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
5366 if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
5367 {
5368 /* Initialize the small common section. */
5369 mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
5370 mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
5371 mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5372 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5373 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
5374 mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
5375 mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
5376 mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5377 mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5378 }
5379 asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5380 asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
5381 break;
5382
5383 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
5384 asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
5385 break;
5386
5387 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
5388 {
5389 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".text");
5390
5391 BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
5392 if (section != NULL)
5393 {
5394 asym->section = section;
5395 /* MIPS_TEXT is a bit special, the address is not an offset
5396 to the base of the .text section. So substract the section
5397 base address to make it an offset. */
5398 asym->value -= section->vma;
5399 }
5400 }
5401 break;
5402
5403 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
5404 {
5405 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".data");
5406
5407 BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
5408 if (section != NULL)
5409 {
5410 asym->section = section;
5411 /* MIPS_DATA is a bit special, the address is not an offset
5412 to the base of the .data section. So substract the section
5413 base address to make it an offset. */
5414 asym->value -= section->vma;
5415 }
5416 }
5417 break;
5418 }
5419 }
5420 \f
5421 /* Implement elf_backend_eh_frame_address_size. This differs from
5422 the default in the way it handles EABI64.
5423
5424 EABI64 was originally specified as an LP64 ABI, and that is what
5425 -mabi=eabi normally gives on a 64-bit target. However, gcc has
5426 historically accepted the combination of -mabi=eabi and -mlong32,
5427 and this ILP32 variation has become semi-official over time.
5428 Both forms use elf32 and have pointer-sized FDE addresses.
5429
5430 If an EABI object was generated by GCC 4.0 or above, it will have
5431 an empty .gcc_compiled_longXX section, where XX is the size of longs
5432 in bits. Unfortunately, ILP32 objects generated by earlier compilers
5433 have no special marking to distinguish them from LP64 objects.
5434
5435 We don't want users of the official LP64 ABI to be punished for the
5436 existence of the ILP32 variant, but at the same time, we don't want
5437 to mistakenly interpret pre-4.0 ILP32 objects as being LP64 objects.
5438 We therefore take the following approach:
5439
5440 - If ABFD contains a .gcc_compiled_longXX section, use it to
5441 determine the pointer size.
5442
5443 - Otherwise check the type of the first relocation. Assume that
5444 the LP64 ABI is being used if the relocation is of type R_MIPS_64.
5445
5446 - Otherwise punt.
5447
5448 The second check is enough to detect LP64 objects generated by pre-4.0
5449 compilers because, in the kind of output generated by those compilers,
5450 the first relocation will be associated with either a CIE personality
5451 routine or an FDE start address. Furthermore, the compilers never
5452 used a special (non-pointer) encoding for this ABI.
5453
5454 Checking the relocation type should also be safe because there is no
5455 reason to use R_MIPS_64 in an ILP32 object. Pre-4.0 compilers never
5456 did so. */
5457
5458 unsigned int
5459 _bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
5460 {
5461 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
5462 return 8;
5463 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
5464 {
5465 bfd_boolean long32_p, long64_p;
5466
5467 long32_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long32") != 0;
5468 long64_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long64") != 0;
5469 if (long32_p && long64_p)
5470 return 0;
5471 if (long32_p)
5472 return 4;
5473 if (long64_p)
5474 return 8;
5475
5476 if (sec->reloc_count > 0
5477 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != NULL
5478 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs[0].r_info)
5479 == R_MIPS_64))
5480 return 8;
5481
5482 return 0;
5483 }
5484 return 4;
5485 }
5486 \f
5487 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
5488 relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
5489 same address. For example, if we have code like:
5490
5491 lw $4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
5492 lw $25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
5493 jalr $25
5494
5495 then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
5496 will jump there rather than to .text.
5497
5498 We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
5499 This is also what the MIPSpro tools do. */
5500
5501 bfd_boolean
5502 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
5503 {
5504 return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
5505 }
5506 \f
5507 /* Work over a section just before writing it out. This routine is
5508 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. FIXME: We recognize
5509 sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
5510 a better way. */
5511
5512 bfd_boolean
5513 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
5514 {
5515 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
5516 && hdr->sh_size > 0)
5517 {
5518 bfd_byte buf[4];
5519
5520 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
5521 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
5522
5523 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5524 hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
5525 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5526 return FALSE;
5527 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5528 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
5529 return FALSE;
5530 }
5531
5532 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
5533 && hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5534 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
5535 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
5536 {
5537 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
5538
5539 /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
5540 set_section_contents routine. We save the section contents
5541 so that we don't have to read them again.
5542 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
5543 through the section contents to see if there is an
5544 ODK_REGINFO structure. */
5545
5546 contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
5547 l = contents;
5548 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
5549 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
5550 {
5551 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
5552
5553 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5554 &intopt);
5555 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5556 {
5557 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5558 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5559 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5560 break;
5561 }
5562 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5563 {
5564 bfd_byte buf[8];
5565
5566 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5567 (hdr->sh_offset
5568 + (l - contents)
5569 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5570 + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
5571 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5572 return FALSE;
5573 H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5574 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
5575 return FALSE;
5576 }
5577 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5578 {
5579 bfd_byte buf[4];
5580
5581 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5582 (hdr->sh_offset
5583 + (l - contents)
5584 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5585 + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
5586 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5587 return FALSE;
5588 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5589 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
5590 return FALSE;
5591 }
5592 l += intopt.size;
5593 }
5594 }
5595
5596 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
5597 {
5598 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
5599
5600 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5601 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
5602 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
5603 {
5604 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5605 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5606 }
5607 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
5608 {
5609 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5610 hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
5611 }
5612 else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
5613 {
5614 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5615 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5616 }
5617 else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
5618 {
5619 hdr->sh_flags = 0;
5620 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5621 }
5622 else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
5623 {
5624 if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
5625 {
5626 unsigned int adjust;
5627
5628 adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
5629 if (adjust != 0)
5630 hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
5631 }
5632 }
5633 }
5634
5635 return TRUE;
5636 }
5637
5638 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file. This
5639 is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
5640 This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
5641
5642 FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
5643 how to. */
5644
5645 bfd_boolean
5646 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
5647 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
5648 const char *name,
5649 int shindex)
5650 {
5651 flagword flags = 0;
5652
5653 /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
5654 at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the
5655 sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives
5656 suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
5657 probably get away with this. */
5658 switch (hdr->sh_type)
5659 {
5660 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
5661 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
5662 return FALSE;
5663 break;
5664 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
5665 if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
5666 return FALSE;
5667 break;
5668 case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
5669 if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
5670 return FALSE;
5671 break;
5672 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
5673 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
5674 return FALSE;
5675 break;
5676 case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
5677 if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
5678 return FALSE;
5679 break;
5680 case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
5681 if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
5682 return FALSE;
5683 flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
5684 break;
5685 case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
5686 if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
5687 || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
5688 return FALSE;
5689 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
5690 break;
5691 case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
5692 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
5693 return FALSE;
5694 break;
5695 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
5696 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
5697 return FALSE;
5698 break;
5699 case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
5700 if (!MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5701 return FALSE;
5702 break;
5703 case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
5704 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_")
5705 && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".zdebug_"))
5706 return FALSE;
5707 break;
5708 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
5709 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
5710 return FALSE;
5711 break;
5712 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
5713 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
5714 && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
5715 return FALSE;
5716 break;
5717 default:
5718 break;
5719 }
5720
5721 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
5722 return FALSE;
5723
5724 if (flags)
5725 {
5726 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5727 (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
5728 hdr->bfd_section)
5729 | flags)))
5730 return FALSE;
5731 }
5732
5733 /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section. */
5734
5735 /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
5736 from the contents of this section. We need the gp value while
5737 processing relocs, so we just get it now. The .reginfo section
5738 is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI. */
5739 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
5740 {
5741 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
5742 Elf32_RegInfo s;
5743
5744 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5745 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
5746 return FALSE;
5747 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
5748 elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
5749 }
5750
5751 /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
5752 set the gp value based on what we find. We may see both
5753 SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
5754 they should agree. */
5755 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
5756 {
5757 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
5758
5759 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
5760 if (contents == NULL)
5761 return FALSE;
5762 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
5763 0, hdr->sh_size))
5764 {
5765 free (contents);
5766 return FALSE;
5767 }
5768 l = contents;
5769 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
5770 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
5771 {
5772 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
5773
5774 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5775 &intopt);
5776 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5777 {
5778 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5779 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5780 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5781 break;
5782 }
5783 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5784 {
5785 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
5786
5787 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
5788 (abfd,
5789 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
5790 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5791 &intreg);
5792 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5793 }
5794 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5795 {
5796 Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
5797
5798 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
5799 (abfd,
5800 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
5801 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5802 &intreg);
5803 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5804 }
5805 l += intopt.size;
5806 }
5807 free (contents);
5808 }
5809
5810 return TRUE;
5811 }
5812
5813 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section. We do this by the
5814 section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. This routine is
5815 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
5816
5817 bfd_boolean
5818 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
5819 {
5820 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
5821
5822 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
5823 {
5824 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
5825 hdr->sh_info = sec->size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
5826 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
5827 }
5828 else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
5829 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
5830 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
5831 {
5832 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
5833 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
5834 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
5835 }
5836 else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
5837 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
5838 else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
5839 {
5840 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
5841 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
5842 entsize of 0. FIXME: Does this matter? */
5843 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5844 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5845 else
5846 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5847 }
5848 else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
5849 {
5850 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
5851 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
5852 entsize of 0x18. FIXME: Does this matter? */
5853 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5854 {
5855 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5856 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5857 else
5858 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5859 }
5860 else
5861 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5862 }
5863 else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5864 && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
5865 || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
5866 || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
5867 {
5868 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5869 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5870 #if 0
5871 /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves. */
5872 hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
5873 #endif
5874 }
5875 else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
5876 || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
5877 || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5878 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
5879 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
5880 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
5881 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5882 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
5883 {
5884 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
5885 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5886 }
5887 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
5888 {
5889 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
5890 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5891 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
5892 }
5893 else if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5894 {
5895 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
5896 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5897 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5898 }
5899 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_")
5900 || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".zdebug_"))
5901 {
5902 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
5903
5904 /* Irix facilities such as libexc expect a single .debug_frame
5905 per executable, the system ones have NOSTRIP set and the linker
5906 doesn't merge sections with different flags so ... */
5907 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_frame"))
5908 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5909 }
5910 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
5911 {
5912 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
5913 /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
5914 final_write_processing. */
5915 }
5916 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
5917 || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
5918 {
5919 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
5920 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5921 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
5922 }
5923 else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
5924 {
5925 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
5926 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
5927 hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
5928 }
5929
5930 /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
5931 kind of relocations. We used to set up a second header for the
5932 non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
5933 these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
5934 Thus we create those header only on demand now. */
5935
5936 return TRUE;
5937 }
5938
5939 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
5940 index. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
5941 Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
5942 but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
5943 the .scommon section. */
5944
5945 bfd_boolean
5946 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5947 asection *sec, int *retval)
5948 {
5949 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
5950 {
5951 *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5952 return TRUE;
5953 }
5954 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
5955 {
5956 *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
5957 return TRUE;
5958 }
5959 return FALSE;
5960 }
5961 \f
5962 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
5963 file. We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here. */
5964
5965 bfd_boolean
5966 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
5967 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
5968 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5969 asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
5970 {
5971 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5972 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
5973 && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
5974 {
5975 /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name. */
5976 *namep = NULL;
5977 return TRUE;
5978 }
5979
5980 /* Shared objects may have a dynamic symbol '_gp_disp' defined as
5981 a SECTION *ABS*. This causes ld to think it can resolve _gp_disp
5982 by setting a DT_NEEDED for the shared object. Since _gp_disp is
5983 a magic symbol resolved by the linker, we ignore this bogus definition
5984 of _gp_disp. New ABI objects do not suffer from this problem so this
5985 is not done for them. */
5986 if (!NEWABI_P(abfd)
5987 && (sym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
5988 && (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0))
5989 {
5990 *namep = NULL;
5991 return TRUE;
5992 }
5993
5994 switch (sym->st_shndx)
5995 {
5996 case SHN_COMMON:
5997 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
5998 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols. */
5999 if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
6000 || ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_TLS
6001 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
6002 break;
6003 /* Fall through. */
6004 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
6005 *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
6006 (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
6007 *valp = sym->st_size;
6008 break;
6009
6010 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
6011 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
6012 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
6013 {
6014 asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
6015 asection *elf_text_section;
6016 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
6017
6018 elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6019 if (elf_text_section == NULL)
6020 return FALSE;
6021
6022 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
6023 elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6024 if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
6025 return FALSE;
6026
6027 /* Initialize the section. */
6028
6029 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
6030 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
6031
6032 elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
6033 elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
6034
6035 elf_text_section->name = ".text";
6036 elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
6037 elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
6038 elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
6039 elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
6040 elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
6041 elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
6042 }
6043 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
6044 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
6045 so I took it out. */
6046 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
6047 break;
6048
6049 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
6050 /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data? */
6051 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
6052 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
6053 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
6054 {
6055 asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
6056 asection *elf_data_section;
6057 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
6058
6059 elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6060 if (elf_data_section == NULL)
6061 return FALSE;
6062
6063 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
6064 elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6065 if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
6066 return FALSE;
6067
6068 /* Initialize the section. */
6069
6070 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
6071 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
6072
6073 elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
6074 elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
6075
6076 elf_data_section->name = ".data";
6077 elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
6078 elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
6079 elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
6080 elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
6081 elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
6082 elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
6083 }
6084 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
6085 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
6086 so I took it out. */
6087 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
6088 break;
6089
6090 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
6091 *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6092 break;
6093 }
6094
6095 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
6096 && ! info->shared
6097 && info->output_bfd->xvec == abfd->xvec
6098 && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
6099 {
6100 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6101 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
6102
6103 /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic. */
6104 bh = NULL;
6105 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6106 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
6107 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6108 return FALSE;
6109
6110 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6111 h->non_elf = 0;
6112 h->def_regular = 1;
6113 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
6114
6115 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6116 return FALSE;
6117
6118 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
6119 }
6120
6121 /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
6122 odd. This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
6123 the right value when it is loaded into the PC. */
6124 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
6125 ++*valp;
6126
6127 return TRUE;
6128 }
6129
6130 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
6131 symbol. We mark symbols as small common if appropriate. This is
6132 also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol. */
6133
6134 bfd_boolean
6135 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
6136 (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6137 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
6138 asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6139 {
6140 /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
6141 if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
6142 common in the output file. */
6143 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
6144 && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
6145 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
6146
6147 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
6148 sym->st_value &= ~1;
6149
6150 return TRUE;
6151 }
6152 \f
6153 /* Functions for the dynamic linker. */
6154
6155 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object. */
6156
6157 bfd_boolean
6158 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
6159 {
6160 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6161 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
6162 flagword flags;
6163 register asection *s;
6164 const char * const *namep;
6165 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6166
6167 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6168 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
6169 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
6170
6171 /* The psABI requires a read-only .dynamic section, but the VxWorks
6172 EABI doesn't. */
6173 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
6174 {
6175 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
6176 if (s != NULL)
6177 {
6178 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
6179 return FALSE;
6180 }
6181 }
6182
6183 /* We need to create .got section. */
6184 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info, FALSE))
6185 return FALSE;
6186
6187 if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE))
6188 return FALSE;
6189
6190 /* Create .stub section. */
6191 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
6192 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == NULL)
6193 {
6194 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
6195 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd),
6196 flags | SEC_CODE);
6197 if (s == NULL
6198 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
6199 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
6200 return FALSE;
6201 }
6202
6203 if ((IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
6204 && !info->shared
6205 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
6206 {
6207 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".rld_map",
6208 flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY);
6209 if (s == NULL
6210 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
6211 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
6212 return FALSE;
6213 }
6214
6215 /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
6216 alignments of several sections. There is no ABI documentation
6217 indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
6218 the linker takes such action. */
6219 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
6220 {
6221 for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
6222 {
6223 bh = NULL;
6224 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6225 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
6226 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6227 return FALSE;
6228
6229 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6230 h->non_elf = 0;
6231 h->def_regular = 1;
6232 h->type = STT_SECTION;
6233
6234 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6235 return FALSE;
6236 }
6237
6238 /* We need to create a .compact_rel section. */
6239 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6240 {
6241 if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
6242 return FALSE;
6243 }
6244
6245 /* Change alignments of some sections. */
6246 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".hash");
6247 if (s != NULL)
6248 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6249 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
6250 if (s != NULL)
6251 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6252 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
6253 if (s != NULL)
6254 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6255 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
6256 if (s != NULL)
6257 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6258 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
6259 if (s != NULL)
6260 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6261 }
6262
6263 if (!info->shared)
6264 {
6265 const char *name;
6266
6267 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
6268 bh = NULL;
6269 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6270 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
6271 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6272 return FALSE;
6273
6274 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6275 h->non_elf = 0;
6276 h->def_regular = 1;
6277 h->type = STT_SECTION;
6278
6279 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6280 return FALSE;
6281
6282 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
6283 {
6284 /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
6285 and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
6286 the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
6287 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol. */
6288 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map");
6289 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6290
6291 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
6292 bh = NULL;
6293 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6294 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
6295 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6296 return FALSE;
6297
6298 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6299 h->non_elf = 0;
6300 h->def_regular = 1;
6301 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
6302
6303 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6304 return FALSE;
6305 }
6306 }
6307
6308 if (htab->is_vxworks)
6309 {
6310 /* Create the .plt, .rela.plt, .dynbss and .rela.bss sections.
6311 Also create the _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE symbol. */
6312 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
6313 return FALSE;
6314
6315 /* Cache the sections created above. */
6316 htab->sdynbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynbss");
6317 htab->srelbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.bss");
6318 htab->srelplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
6319 htab->splt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
6320 if (!htab->sdynbss
6321 || (!htab->srelbss && !info->shared)
6322 || !htab->srelplt
6323 || !htab->splt)
6324 abort ();
6325
6326 /* Do the usual VxWorks handling. */
6327 if (!elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
6328 return FALSE;
6329
6330 /* Work out the PLT sizes. */
6331 if (info->shared)
6332 {
6333 htab->plt_header_size
6334 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry);
6335 htab->plt_entry_size
6336 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry);
6337 }
6338 else
6339 {
6340 htab->plt_header_size
6341 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry);
6342 htab->plt_entry_size
6343 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry);
6344 }
6345 }
6346
6347 return TRUE;
6348 }
6349 \f
6350 /* Return true if relocation REL against section SEC is a REL rather than
6351 RELA relocation. RELOCS is the first relocation in the section and
6352 ABFD is the bfd that contains SEC. */
6353
6354 static bfd_boolean
6355 mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
6356 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6357 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6358 {
6359 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6360 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6361
6362 /* To determine which flavor or relocation this is, we depend on the
6363 fact that the INPUT_SECTION's REL_HDR is read before its REL_HDR2. */
6364 rel_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr;
6365 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6366 if ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
6367 >= (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel))
6368 rel_hdr = elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr2;
6369 return rel_hdr->sh_entsize == MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
6370 }
6371
6372 /* Read the addend for REL relocation REL, which belongs to bfd ABFD.
6373 HOWTO is the relocation's howto and CONTENTS points to the contents
6374 of the section that REL is against. */
6375
6376 static bfd_vma
6377 mips_elf_read_rel_addend (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
6378 reloc_howto_type *howto, bfd_byte *contents)
6379 {
6380 bfd_byte *location;
6381 unsigned int r_type;
6382 bfd_vma addend;
6383
6384 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
6385 location = contents + rel->r_offset;
6386
6387 /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file. */
6388 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
6389 addend = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, abfd, contents);
6390 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
6391
6392 return addend & howto->src_mask;
6393 }
6394
6395 /* REL is a relocation in ABFD that needs a partnering LO16 relocation
6396 and *ADDEND is the addend for REL itself. Look for the LO16 relocation
6397 and update *ADDEND with the final addend. Return true on success
6398 or false if the LO16 could not be found. RELEND is the exclusive
6399 upper bound on the relocations for REL's section. */
6400
6401 static bfd_boolean
6402 mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (bfd *abfd,
6403 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
6404 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend,
6405 bfd_byte *contents, bfd_vma *addend)
6406 {
6407 unsigned int r_type, lo16_type;
6408 const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
6409 reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
6410 bfd_vma l;
6411
6412 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
6413 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
6414 lo16_type = R_MIPS16_LO16;
6415 else
6416 lo16_type = R_MIPS_LO16;
6417
6418 /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend, left-shifted by
6419 sixteen bits, and the LO16 addend, sign extended. (Usually, the
6420 code does a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of the
6421 LO16 value.)
6422
6423 Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation.
6424
6425 According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation must
6426 be immediately following. However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next
6427 relocation may be a composed relocation consisting of several
6428 relocations for the same address. In that case, the R_MIPS_LO16
6429 relocation may occur as one of these. We permit a similar
6430 extension in general, as that is useful for GCC.
6431
6432 In some cases GCC dead code elimination removes the LO16 but keeps
6433 the corresponding HI16. This is strictly speaking a violation of
6434 the ABI but not immediately harmful. */
6435 lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (abfd, lo16_type, rel, relend);
6436 if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
6437 return FALSE;
6438
6439 /* Obtain the addend kept there. */
6440 lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, lo16_type, FALSE);
6441 l = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (abfd, lo16_relocation, lo16_howto, contents);
6442
6443 l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
6444 l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
6445
6446 *addend <<= 16;
6447 *addend += l;
6448 return TRUE;
6449 }
6450
6451 /* Try to read the contents of section SEC in bfd ABFD. Return true and
6452 store the contents in *CONTENTS on success. Assume that *CONTENTS
6453 already holds the contents if it is nonull on entry. */
6454
6455 static bfd_boolean
6456 mips_elf_get_section_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, bfd_byte **contents)
6457 {
6458 if (*contents)
6459 return TRUE;
6460
6461 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6462 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6463 {
6464 *contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
6465 return TRUE;
6466 }
6467
6468 return bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, contents);
6469 }
6470
6471 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
6472 allocate space in the global offset table. */
6473
6474 bfd_boolean
6475 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
6476 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
6477 {
6478 const char *name;
6479 bfd *dynobj;
6480 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6481 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6482 struct mips_got_info *g;
6483 size_t extsymoff;
6484 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6485 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
6486 asection *sgot;
6487 asection *sreloc;
6488 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6489 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6490 bfd_byte *contents;
6491 bfd_vma addend;
6492 reloc_howto_type *howto;
6493
6494 if (info->relocatable)
6495 return TRUE;
6496
6497 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6498 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6499 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6500 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
6501 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6502
6503 /* Check for the mips16 stub sections. */
6504
6505 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
6506 if (FN_STUB_P (name))
6507 {
6508 unsigned long r_symndx;
6509
6510 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
6511 this is for. */
6512
6513 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
6514
6515 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
6516 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
6517 {
6518 asection *o;
6519
6520 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
6521 needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
6522 than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol. */
6523 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
6524 {
6525 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
6526 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
6527
6528 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
6529 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
6530 || o->reloc_count == 0
6531 || mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, o))
6532 continue;
6533
6534 sec_relocs
6535 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
6536 info->keep_memory);
6537 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
6538 return FALSE;
6539
6540 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
6541 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
6542 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
6543 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) != R_MIPS16_26)
6544 break;
6545
6546 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
6547 free (sec_relocs);
6548
6549 if (r < rend)
6550 break;
6551 }
6552
6553 if (o == NULL)
6554 {
6555 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
6556 not need it. Since this function is called before
6557 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
6558 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
6559 flag. */
6560 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6561 return TRUE;
6562 }
6563
6564 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
6565 this BFD. */
6566 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
6567 {
6568 unsigned long symcount;
6569 asection **n;
6570 bfd_size_type amt;
6571
6572 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
6573 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
6574 else
6575 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6576 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
6577 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6578 if (n == NULL)
6579 return FALSE;
6580 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
6581 }
6582
6583 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6584 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
6585
6586 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
6587 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
6588 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
6589 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
6590 }
6591 else
6592 {
6593 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6594
6595 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6596 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6597
6598 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6599 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6600 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
6601
6602 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
6603
6604 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
6605 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
6606 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
6607 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
6608 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
6609 if (h->fn_stub != NULL)
6610 {
6611 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6612 return TRUE;
6613 }
6614
6615 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6616 h->fn_stub = sec;
6617 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
6618 }
6619 }
6620 else if (CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
6621 {
6622 unsigned long r_symndx;
6623 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6624 asection **loc;
6625
6626 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
6627 this is for. */
6628
6629 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
6630
6631 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
6632 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
6633 {
6634 asection *o;
6635
6636 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
6637 needed if there is some relocation (R_MIPS16_26) in this BFD
6638 that refers to this symbol. */
6639 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
6640 {
6641 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
6642 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
6643
6644 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
6645 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
6646 || o->reloc_count == 0
6647 || mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, o))
6648 continue;
6649
6650 sec_relocs
6651 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
6652 info->keep_memory);
6653 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
6654 return FALSE;
6655
6656 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
6657 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
6658 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
6659 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) == R_MIPS16_26)
6660 break;
6661
6662 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
6663 free (sec_relocs);
6664
6665 if (r < rend)
6666 break;
6667 }
6668
6669 if (o == NULL)
6670 {
6671 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
6672 not need it. Since this function is called before
6673 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
6674 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
6675 flag. */
6676 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6677 return TRUE;
6678 }
6679
6680 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol call_stubs for
6681 this BFD. */
6682 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs == NULL)
6683 {
6684 unsigned long symcount;
6685 asection **n;
6686 bfd_size_type amt;
6687
6688 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
6689 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
6690 else
6691 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6692 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
6693 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6694 if (n == NULL)
6695 return FALSE;
6696 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs = n;
6697 }
6698
6699 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6700 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
6701
6702 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
6703 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
6704 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
6705 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
6706 }
6707 else
6708 {
6709 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6710 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6711
6712 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
6713
6714 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
6715 loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
6716 else
6717 loc = &h->call_stub;
6718
6719 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
6720 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
6721 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
6722 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
6723 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
6724 if (*loc != NULL)
6725 {
6726 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6727 return TRUE;
6728 }
6729
6730 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6731 *loc = sec;
6732 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
6733 }
6734 }
6735
6736 if (dynobj == NULL)
6737 {
6738 sgot = NULL;
6739 g = NULL;
6740 }
6741 else
6742 {
6743 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
6744 if (sgot == NULL)
6745 g = NULL;
6746 else
6747 {
6748 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
6749 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
6750 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
6751 }
6752 }
6753
6754 sreloc = NULL;
6755 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6756 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6757 contents = NULL;
6758 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
6759 {
6760 unsigned long r_symndx;
6761 unsigned int r_type;
6762 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6763
6764 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
6765 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
6766
6767 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
6768 h = NULL;
6769 else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
6770 {
6771 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6772 (_("%B: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
6773 abfd, name);
6774 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6775 return FALSE;
6776 }
6777 else
6778 {
6779 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
6780
6781 /* This may be an indirect symbol created because of a version. */
6782 if (h != NULL)
6783 {
6784 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6785 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
6786 }
6787 }
6788
6789 /* Some relocs require a global offset table. */
6790 if (dynobj == NULL || sgot == NULL)
6791 {
6792 switch (r_type)
6793 {
6794 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6795 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6796 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6797 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6798 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6799 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6800 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6801 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
6802 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6803 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6804 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6805 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6806 if (dynobj == NULL)
6807 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6808 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, FALSE))
6809 return FALSE;
6810 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6811 if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
6812 {
6813 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6814 (_("%B: GOT reloc at 0x%lx not expected in executables"),
6815 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
6816 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6817 return FALSE;
6818 }
6819 break;
6820
6821 case R_MIPS_32:
6822 case R_MIPS_REL32:
6823 case R_MIPS_64:
6824 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
6825 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
6826 no need to add a dynamic relocation here. */
6827 if (dynobj == NULL
6828 && (info->shared || (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks))
6829 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6830 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6831 break;
6832
6833 default:
6834 break;
6835 }
6836 }
6837
6838 if (h)
6839 {
6840 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_relocation_target = TRUE;
6841
6842 /* Relocations against the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and
6843 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols must be left to the loader. Allocate
6844 room for them in .rela.dyn. */
6845 if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
6846 {
6847 if (sreloc == NULL)
6848 {
6849 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
6850 if (sreloc == NULL)
6851 return FALSE;
6852 }
6853 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
6854 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6855 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
6856 relocations against the text segment. */
6857 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6858 }
6859 }
6860 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
6861 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16
6862 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP
6863 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 && htab->is_vxworks))
6864 {
6865 /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation. We
6866 don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
6867 maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
6868 the segment. Similar comments apply to R_MIPS_GOT16 and
6869 R_MIPS_CALL16, except on VxWorks, where GOT relocations
6870 always evaluate to "G". We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
6871 R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
6872 R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16. */
6873 if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6874 rel->r_addend, g, 0))
6875 return FALSE;
6876 }
6877
6878 switch (r_type)
6879 {
6880 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6881 if (h == NULL)
6882 {
6883 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6884 (_("%B: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"),
6885 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
6886 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6887 return FALSE;
6888 }
6889 /* Fall through. */
6890
6891 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6892 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6893 if (h != NULL)
6894 {
6895 /* VxWorks call relocations point the function's .got.plt
6896 entry, which will be allocated by adjust_dynamic_symbol.
6897 Otherwise, this symbol requires a global GOT entry. */
6898 if ((!htab->is_vxworks || h->forced_local)
6899 && !mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6900 return FALSE;
6901
6902 /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
6903 function. But we record it as if it needs plt. See
6904 _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
6905 h->needs_plt = 1;
6906 h->type = STT_FUNC;
6907 }
6908 break;
6909
6910 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6911 /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
6912 decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it. */
6913 if (h)
6914 {
6915 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6916 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6917
6918 while (hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6919 || hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6920 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6921 hmips->root.root.u.i.link;
6922
6923 /* This symbol is definitely not overridable. */
6924 if (hmips->root.def_regular
6925 && ! (info->shared && ! info->symbolic
6926 && ! hmips->root.forced_local))
6927 h = NULL;
6928 }
6929 /* Fall through. */
6930
6931 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6932 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6933 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6934 if (!h || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE)
6935 {
6936 /* This relocation needs (or may need, if h != NULL) a
6937 page entry in the GOT. For R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE we do not
6938 know for sure until we know whether the symbol is
6939 preemptible. */
6940 if (mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (abfd, sec, relocs, rel))
6941 {
6942 if (!mips_elf_get_section_contents (abfd, sec, &contents))
6943 return FALSE;
6944 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, r_type, FALSE);
6945 addend = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (abfd, rel,
6946 howto, contents);
6947 if (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
6948 mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (abfd, rel, rel_end,
6949 contents, &addend);
6950 else
6951 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
6952 }
6953 else
6954 addend = rel->r_addend;
6955 if (!mips_elf_record_got_page_entry (abfd, r_symndx, addend, g))
6956 return FALSE;
6957 break;
6958 }
6959 /* Fall through. */
6960
6961 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6962 if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6963 return FALSE;
6964 break;
6965
6966 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6967 if (info->shared)
6968 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
6969 /* Fall through */
6970
6971 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6972 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
6973 {
6974 r_symndx = 0;
6975 h = NULL;
6976 }
6977 /* Fall through */
6978
6979 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6980 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry, or two
6981 for TLS GD relocations. */
6982 {
6983 unsigned char flag = (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
6984 ? GOT_TLS_GD
6985 : r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM
6986 ? GOT_TLS_LDM
6987 : GOT_TLS_IE);
6988 if (h != NULL)
6989 {
6990 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6991 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6992 hmips->tls_type |= flag;
6993
6994 if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, flag))
6995 return FALSE;
6996 }
6997 else
6998 {
6999 BFD_ASSERT (flag == GOT_TLS_LDM || r_symndx != 0);
7000
7001 if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
7002 rel->r_addend, g, flag))
7003 return FALSE;
7004 }
7005 }
7006 break;
7007
7008 case R_MIPS_32:
7009 case R_MIPS_REL32:
7010 case R_MIPS_64:
7011 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
7012 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
7013 no need to add a .rela.dyn entry for this relocation. */
7014 if ((info->shared || (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks))
7015 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7016 {
7017 if (sreloc == NULL)
7018 {
7019 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
7020 if (sreloc == NULL)
7021 return FALSE;
7022 }
7023 if (info->shared)
7024 {
7025 /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
7026 reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
7027 relocs. Make room for this reloc in .rel(a).dyn. */
7028 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
7029 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
7030 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
7031 relocations against the text segment. */
7032 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
7033 }
7034 else
7035 {
7036 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
7037
7038 /* We only need to copy this reloc if the symbol is
7039 defined in a dynamic object. */
7040 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
7041 ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
7042 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
7043 /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
7044 are relocations against the text segment. */
7045 hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
7046 }
7047
7048 /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for
7049 this symbol, a symbol must have a dynamic symbol
7050 table index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are
7051 dynamic relocations against it. This does not apply
7052 to VxWorks, which does not have the usual coupling
7053 between global GOT entries and .dynsym entries. */
7054 if (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
7055 {
7056 if (dynobj == NULL)
7057 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
7058 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, TRUE))
7059 return FALSE;
7060 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
7061 if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
7062 return FALSE;
7063 }
7064 }
7065
7066 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
7067 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
7068 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
7069 break;
7070
7071 case R_MIPS_PC16:
7072 if (h)
7073 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_branch_target = TRUE;
7074 break;
7075
7076 case R_MIPS_26:
7077 if (h)
7078 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_branch_target = TRUE;
7079 /* Fall through. */
7080
7081 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
7082 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
7083 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
7084 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
7085 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
7086 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
7087 break;
7088
7089 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
7090 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
7091 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7092 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
7093 return FALSE;
7094 break;
7095
7096 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
7097 used. Record for later use during GC. */
7098 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
7099 BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
7100 if (h != NULL
7101 && !bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
7102 return FALSE;
7103 break;
7104
7105 default:
7106 break;
7107 }
7108
7109 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
7110 related to taking the function's address. This doesn't apply to
7111 VxWorks, where CALL relocs refer to a .got.plt entry instead of
7112 a normal .got entry. */
7113 if (!htab->is_vxworks && h != NULL)
7114 switch (r_type)
7115 {
7116 default:
7117 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
7118 break;
7119 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
7120 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
7121 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
7122 case R_MIPS_JALR:
7123 break;
7124 }
7125
7126 /* If this reloc is not a 16 bit call, and it has a global
7127 symbol, then we will need the fn_stub if there is one.
7128 References from a stub section do not count. */
7129 if (h != NULL
7130 && r_type != R_MIPS16_26
7131 && !mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, sec))
7132 {
7133 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
7134
7135 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
7136 mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
7137 }
7138 }
7139
7140 return TRUE;
7141 }
7142 \f
7143 bfd_boolean
7144 _bfd_mips_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
7145 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
7146 bfd_boolean *again)
7147 {
7148 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
7149 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
7150 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7151 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
7152 size_t extsymoff;
7153 bfd_boolean changed_contents = FALSE;
7154 bfd_vma sec_start = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
7155 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
7156
7157 /* We are not currently changing any sizes, so only one pass. */
7158 *again = FALSE;
7159
7160 if (link_info->relocatable)
7161 return TRUE;
7162
7163 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7164 link_info->keep_memory);
7165 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
7166 return TRUE;
7167
7168 irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count
7169 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
7170 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7171 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7172
7173 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
7174 {
7175 bfd_vma symval;
7176 bfd_signed_vma sym_offset;
7177 unsigned int r_type;
7178 unsigned long r_symndx;
7179 asection *sym_sec;
7180 unsigned long instruction;
7181
7182 /* Turn jalr into bgezal, and jr into beq, if they're marked
7183 with a JALR relocation, that indicate where they jump to.
7184 This saves some pipeline bubbles. */
7185 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, irel->r_info);
7186 if (r_type != R_MIPS_JALR)
7187 continue;
7188
7189 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, irel->r_info);
7190 /* Compute the address of the jump target. */
7191 if (r_symndx >= extsymoff)
7192 {
7193 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h
7194 = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
7195 elf_sym_hashes (abfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
7196
7197 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
7198 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
7199 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
7200
7201 /* If a symbol is undefined, or if it may be overridden,
7202 skip it. */
7203 if (! ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7204 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7205 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
7206 || (link_info->shared && ! link_info->symbolic
7207 && !h->root.forced_local))
7208 continue;
7209
7210 sym_sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
7211 if (sym_sec->output_section)
7212 symval = (h->root.root.u.def.value
7213 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
7214 + sym_sec->output_offset);
7215 else
7216 symval = h->root.root.u.def.value;
7217 }
7218 else
7219 {
7220 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
7221
7222 /* Read this BFD's symbols if we haven't done so already. */
7223 if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
7224 {
7225 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
7226 if (isymbuf == NULL)
7227 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
7228 symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
7229 NULL, NULL, NULL);
7230 if (isymbuf == NULL)
7231 goto relax_return;
7232 }
7233
7234 isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
7235 if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
7236 continue;
7237 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
7238 sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
7239 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
7240 sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
7241 else
7242 sym_sec
7243 = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
7244 symval = isym->st_value
7245 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
7246 + sym_sec->output_offset;
7247 }
7248
7249 /* Compute branch offset, from delay slot of the jump to the
7250 branch target. */
7251 sym_offset = (symval + irel->r_addend)
7252 - (sec_start + irel->r_offset + 4);
7253
7254 /* Branch offset must be properly aligned. */
7255 if ((sym_offset & 3) != 0)
7256 continue;
7257
7258 sym_offset >>= 2;
7259
7260 /* Check that it's in range. */
7261 if (sym_offset < -0x8000 || sym_offset >= 0x8000)
7262 continue;
7263
7264 /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
7265 if (!mips_elf_get_section_contents (abfd, sec, &contents))
7266 goto relax_return;
7267
7268 instruction = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
7269
7270 /* If it was jalr <reg>, turn it into bgezal $zero, <target>. */
7271 if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x0000f809)
7272 instruction = 0x04110000;
7273 /* If it was jr <reg>, turn it into b <target>. */
7274 else if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x00000008)
7275 instruction = 0x10000000;
7276 else
7277 continue;
7278
7279 instruction |= (sym_offset & 0xffff);
7280 bfd_put_32 (abfd, instruction, contents + irel->r_offset);
7281 changed_contents = TRUE;
7282 }
7283
7284 if (contents != NULL
7285 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
7286 {
7287 if (!changed_contents && !link_info->keep_memory)
7288 free (contents);
7289 else
7290 {
7291 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
7292 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
7293 }
7294 }
7295 return TRUE;
7296
7297 relax_return:
7298 if (contents != NULL
7299 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
7300 free (contents);
7301 return FALSE;
7302 }
7303 \f
7304 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
7305 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
7306 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
7307 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
7308 understand. */
7309
7310 bfd_boolean
7311 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
7312 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
7313 {
7314 bfd *dynobj;
7315 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
7316 asection *s;
7317 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7318
7319 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7320 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7321
7322 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
7323 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
7324 && (h->needs_plt
7325 || h->u.weakdef != NULL
7326 || (h->def_dynamic
7327 && h->ref_regular
7328 && !h->def_regular)));
7329
7330 /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, we need to copy
7331 any R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output
7332 file. */
7333 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
7334 if (! info->relocatable
7335 && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
7336 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
7337 || !h->def_regular))
7338 {
7339 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations
7340 (dynobj, info, hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
7341 if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
7342 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
7343 against the text segment. */
7344 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
7345 }
7346
7347 /* For a function, create a stub, if allowed. */
7348 if (! hmips->no_fn_stub
7349 && h->needs_plt)
7350 {
7351 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7352 return TRUE;
7353
7354 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
7355 the symbol to the stub location. This is required to make
7356 function pointers compare as equal between the normal
7357 executable and the shared library. */
7358 if (!h->def_regular)
7359 {
7360 /* We need .stub section. */
7361 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
7362 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
7363 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7364
7365 h->root.u.def.section = s;
7366 h->root.u.def.value = s->size;
7367
7368 /* XXX Write this stub address somewhere. */
7369 h->plt.offset = s->size;
7370
7371 /* Make room for this stub code. */
7372 s->size += htab->function_stub_size;
7373
7374 /* The last half word of the stub will be filled with the index
7375 of this symbol in .dynsym section. */
7376 return TRUE;
7377 }
7378 }
7379 else if ((h->type == STT_FUNC)
7380 && !h->needs_plt)
7381 {
7382 /* This will set the entry for this symbol in the GOT to 0, and
7383 the dynamic linker will take care of this. */
7384 h->root.u.def.value = 0;
7385 return TRUE;
7386 }
7387
7388 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
7389 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
7390 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
7391 if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
7392 {
7393 BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7394 || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
7395 h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
7396 h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
7397 return TRUE;
7398 }
7399
7400 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
7401 is not a function. */
7402
7403 return TRUE;
7404 }
7405
7406 /* Likewise, for VxWorks. */
7407
7408 bfd_boolean
7409 _bfd_mips_vxworks_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
7410 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
7411 {
7412 bfd *dynobj;
7413 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
7414 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7415
7416 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7417 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7418 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
7419
7420 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
7421 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
7422 && (h->needs_plt
7423 || h->needs_copy
7424 || h->u.weakdef != NULL
7425 || (h->def_dynamic
7426 && h->ref_regular
7427 && !h->def_regular)));
7428
7429 /* If the symbol is defined by a dynamic object, we need a PLT stub if
7430 either (a) we want to branch to the symbol or (b) we're linking an
7431 executable that needs a canonical function address. In the latter
7432 case, the canonical address will be the address of the executable's
7433 load stub. */
7434 if ((hmips->is_branch_target
7435 || (!info->shared
7436 && h->type == STT_FUNC
7437 && hmips->is_relocation_target))
7438 && h->def_dynamic
7439 && h->ref_regular
7440 && !h->def_regular
7441 && !h->forced_local)
7442 h->needs_plt = 1;
7443
7444 /* Locally-binding symbols do not need a PLT stub; we can refer to
7445 the functions directly. */
7446 else if (h->needs_plt
7447 && (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
7448 || (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT
7449 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)))
7450 {
7451 h->needs_plt = 0;
7452 return TRUE;
7453 }
7454
7455 if (h->needs_plt)
7456 {
7457 /* If this is the first symbol to need a PLT entry, allocate room
7458 for the header, and for the header's .rela.plt.unloaded entries. */
7459 if (htab->splt->size == 0)
7460 {
7461 htab->splt->size += htab->plt_header_size;
7462 if (!info->shared)
7463 htab->srelplt2->size += 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7464 }
7465
7466 /* Assign the next .plt entry to this symbol. */
7467 h->plt.offset = htab->splt->size;
7468 htab->splt->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
7469
7470 /* If the output file has no definition of the symbol, set the
7471 symbol's value to the address of the stub. Point at the PLT
7472 load stub rather than the lazy resolution stub; this stub
7473 will become the canonical function address. */
7474 if (!info->shared && !h->def_regular)
7475 {
7476 h->root.u.def.section = htab->splt;
7477 h->root.u.def.value = h->plt.offset;
7478 h->root.u.def.value += 8;
7479 }
7480
7481 /* Make room for the .got.plt entry and the R_JUMP_SLOT relocation. */
7482 htab->sgotplt->size += 4;
7483 htab->srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7484
7485 /* Make room for the .rela.plt.unloaded relocations. */
7486 if (!info->shared)
7487 htab->srelplt2->size += 3 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7488
7489 return TRUE;
7490 }
7491
7492 /* If a function symbol is defined by a dynamic object, and we do not
7493 need a PLT stub for it, the symbol's value should be zero. */
7494 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
7495 && h->def_dynamic
7496 && h->ref_regular
7497 && !h->def_regular)
7498 {
7499 h->root.u.def.value = 0;
7500 return TRUE;
7501 }
7502
7503 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
7504 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
7505 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
7506 if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
7507 {
7508 BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7509 || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
7510 h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
7511 h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
7512 return TRUE;
7513 }
7514
7515 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
7516 is not a function. */
7517 if (info->shared)
7518 return TRUE;
7519
7520 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
7521 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
7522 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
7523 object will contain position independent code, so all references
7524 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
7525 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
7526 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
7527 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
7528 same memory location for the variable. */
7529
7530 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7531 {
7532 htab->srelbss->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7533 h->needs_copy = 1;
7534 }
7535
7536 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (h, htab->sdynbss);
7537 }
7538 \f
7539 /* Return the number of dynamic section symbols required by OUTPUT_BFD.
7540 The number might be exact or a worst-case estimate, depending on how
7541 much information is available to elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym at
7542 the current linking stage. */
7543
7544 static bfd_size_type
7545 count_section_dynsyms (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
7546 {
7547 bfd_size_type count;
7548
7549 count = 0;
7550 if (info->shared || elf_hash_table (info)->is_relocatable_executable)
7551 {
7552 asection *p;
7553 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7554
7555 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
7556 for (p = output_bfd->sections; p ; p = p->next)
7557 if ((p->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
7558 && (p->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
7559 && !(*bed->elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym) (output_bfd, info, p))
7560 ++count;
7561 }
7562 return count;
7563 }
7564
7565 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
7566 and the input sections have been assigned to output sections. We
7567 check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard. */
7568
7569 bfd_boolean
7570 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
7571 struct bfd_link_info *info)
7572 {
7573 asection *ri;
7574
7575 bfd *dynobj;
7576 asection *s;
7577 struct mips_got_info *g;
7578 int i;
7579 bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
7580 bfd_size_type page_gotno;
7581 bfd_size_type dynsymcount;
7582 bfd *sub;
7583 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg count_tls_arg;
7584 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7585
7586 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7587
7588 /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size. */
7589 ri = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
7590 if (ri != NULL)
7591 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, ri, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
7592
7593 if (! (info->relocatable
7594 || ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen))
7595 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
7596 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs, NULL);
7597
7598 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7599 if (dynobj == NULL)
7600 /* Relocatable links don't have it. */
7601 return TRUE;
7602
7603 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &s);
7604 if (s == NULL)
7605 return TRUE;
7606
7607 /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output. That
7608 will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
7609 required. */
7610 for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub; sub = sub->link_next)
7611 {
7612 asection *subsection;
7613
7614 for (subsection = sub->sections;
7615 subsection;
7616 subsection = subsection->next)
7617 {
7618 if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
7619 continue;
7620 loadable_size += ((subsection->size + 0xf)
7621 &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
7622 }
7623 }
7624
7625 /* There has to be a global GOT entry for every symbol with
7626 a dynamic symbol table index of DT_MIPS_GOTSYM or
7627 higher. Therefore, it make sense to put those symbols
7628 that need GOT entries at the end of the symbol table. We
7629 do that here. */
7630 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
7631 return FALSE;
7632
7633 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
7634 i = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - g->global_gotsym->dynindx;
7635 else
7636 /* If there are no global symbols, or none requiring
7637 relocations, then GLOBAL_GOTSYM will be NULL. */
7638 i = 0;
7639
7640 /* Get a worst-case estimate of the number of dynamic symbols needed.
7641 At this point, dynsymcount does not account for section symbols
7642 and count_section_dynsyms may overestimate the number that will
7643 be needed. */
7644 dynsymcount = (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
7645 + count_section_dynsyms (output_bfd, info));
7646
7647 /* Determine the size of one stub entry. */
7648 htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
7649 ? MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
7650 : MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
7651
7652 /* In the worst case, we'll get one stub per dynamic symbol, plus
7653 one to account for the dummy entry at the end required by IRIX
7654 rld. */
7655 loadable_size += htab->function_stub_size * (i + 1);
7656
7657 if (htab->is_vxworks)
7658 /* There's no need to allocate page entries for VxWorks; R_MIPS_GOT16
7659 relocations against local symbols evaluate to "G", and the EABI does
7660 not include R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE. */
7661 page_gotno = 0;
7662 else
7663 /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of contiguous
7664 sections. Is 5 enough? */
7665 page_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
7666
7667 /* Choose the smaller of the two estimates; both are intended to be
7668 conservative. */
7669 if (page_gotno > g->page_gotno)
7670 page_gotno = g->page_gotno;
7671
7672 g->local_gotno += page_gotno;
7673 s->size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7674
7675 g->global_gotno = i;
7676 s->size += i * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7677
7678 /* We need to calculate tls_gotno for global symbols at this point
7679 instead of building it up earlier, to avoid doublecounting
7680 entries for one global symbol from multiple input files. */
7681 count_tls_arg.info = info;
7682 count_tls_arg.needed = 0;
7683 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
7684 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries,
7685 &count_tls_arg);
7686 g->tls_gotno += count_tls_arg.needed;
7687 s->size += g->tls_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7688
7689 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
7690
7691 /* VxWorks does not support multiple GOTs. It initializes $gp to
7692 __GOTT_BASE__[__GOTT_INDEX__], the value of which is set by the
7693 dynamic loader. */
7694 if (!htab->is_vxworks && s->size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info))
7695 {
7696 if (! mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, g, s, page_gotno))
7697 return FALSE;
7698 }
7699 else
7700 {
7701 /* Set up TLS entries for the first GOT. */
7702 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno;
7703 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
7704 }
7705 htab->computed_got_sizes = TRUE;
7706
7707 return TRUE;
7708 }
7709
7710 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
7711
7712 bfd_boolean
7713 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
7714 struct bfd_link_info *info)
7715 {
7716 bfd *dynobj;
7717 asection *s, *sreldyn;
7718 bfd_boolean reltext;
7719 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7720
7721 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7722 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7723 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
7724
7725 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7726 {
7727 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
7728 if (info->executable)
7729 {
7730 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
7731 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7732 s->size
7733 = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
7734 s->contents
7735 = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
7736 }
7737 }
7738
7739 /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
7740 determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate
7741 memory for them. */
7742 reltext = FALSE;
7743 sreldyn = NULL;
7744 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7745 {
7746 const char *name;
7747
7748 /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
7749 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
7750 name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
7751
7752 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
7753 continue;
7754
7755 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rel"))
7756 {
7757 if (s->size != 0)
7758 {
7759 const char *outname;
7760 asection *target;
7761
7762 /* If this relocation section applies to a read only
7763 section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
7764 If the relocation section is .rel(a).dyn, we always
7765 assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
7766 there exists a relocation to a read only section or
7767 not. */
7768 outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
7769 s->output_section);
7770 target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
7771 if ((target != NULL
7772 && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
7773 && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7774 || strcmp (outname, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
7775 reltext = TRUE;
7776
7777 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
7778 to copy relocs into the output file. */
7779 if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) != 0)
7780 s->reloc_count = 0;
7781
7782 /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
7783 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
7784 and before we're done creating relocations. Also, it
7785 will move them around between input sections'
7786 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
7787 broken, so don't let it run. */
7788 info->combreloc = 0;
7789 }
7790 }
7791 else if (htab->is_vxworks && strcmp (name, ".got") == 0)
7792 {
7793 /* Executables do not need a GOT. */
7794 if (info->shared)
7795 {
7796 /* Allocate relocations for all but the reserved entries. */
7797 struct mips_got_info *g;
7798 unsigned int count;
7799
7800 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
7801 count = (g->global_gotno
7802 + g->local_gotno
7803 - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info));
7804 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, count);
7805 }
7806 }
7807 else if (!htab->is_vxworks && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".got"))
7808 {
7809 /* _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections() has already done
7810 most of the work, but some symbols may have been mapped
7811 to versions that we must now resolve in the got_entries
7812 hash tables. */
7813 struct mips_got_info *gg = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
7814 struct mips_got_info *g = gg;
7815 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
7816 unsigned int needed_relocs = 0;
7817
7818 if (gg->next)
7819 {
7820 set_got_offset_arg.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7821 set_got_offset_arg.info = info;
7822
7823 /* NOTE 2005-02-03: How can this call, or the next, ever
7824 find any indirect entries to resolve? They were all
7825 resolved in mips_elf_multi_got. */
7826 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (gg);
7827 for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
7828 {
7829 unsigned int save_assign;
7830
7831 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
7832
7833 /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries. */
7834 save_assign = g->assigned_gotno;
7835 g->assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno;
7836 set_got_offset_arg.g = g;
7837 set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs = 0;
7838 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
7839 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
7840 &set_got_offset_arg);
7841 needed_relocs += set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs;
7842 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno - g->local_gotno
7843 <= g->global_gotno);
7844
7845 g->assigned_gotno = save_assign;
7846 if (info->shared)
7847 {
7848 needed_relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_gotno;
7849 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
7850 + g->next->global_gotno
7851 + g->next->tls_gotno
7852 + MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info));
7853 }
7854 }
7855 }
7856 else
7857 {
7858 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg arg;
7859 arg.info = info;
7860 arg.needed = 0;
7861
7862 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs,
7863 &arg);
7864 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
7865 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs,
7866 &arg);
7867
7868 needed_relocs += arg.needed;
7869 }
7870
7871 if (needed_relocs)
7872 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info,
7873 needed_relocs);
7874 }
7875 else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)) == 0)
7876 {
7877 /* IRIX rld assumes that the function stub isn't at the end
7878 of .text section. So put a dummy. XXX */
7879 s->size += htab->function_stub_size;
7880 }
7881 else if (! info->shared
7882 && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
7883 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rld_map"))
7884 {
7885 /* We add a room for __rld_map. It will be filled in by the
7886 rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure. */
7887 s->size += 4;
7888 }
7889 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
7890 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".compact_rel"))
7891 s->size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
7892 else if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".init")
7893 && s != htab->sgotplt
7894 && s != htab->splt)
7895 {
7896 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
7897 continue;
7898 }
7899
7900 if (s->size == 0)
7901 {
7902 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7903 continue;
7904 }
7905
7906 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
7907 continue;
7908
7909 /* Allocate memory for this section last, since we may increase its
7910 size above. */
7911 if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
7912 {
7913 sreldyn = s;
7914 continue;
7915 }
7916
7917 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
7918 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
7919 if (s->contents == NULL)
7920 {
7921 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
7922 return FALSE;
7923 }
7924 }
7925
7926 /* Allocate memory for the .rel(a).dyn section. */
7927 if (sreldyn != NULL)
7928 {
7929 sreldyn->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, sreldyn->size);
7930 if (sreldyn->contents == NULL)
7931 {
7932 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
7933 return FALSE;
7934 }
7935 }
7936
7937 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7938 {
7939 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
7940 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
7941 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
7942 the .dynamic section. */
7943
7944 /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
7945 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry. This must come first because glibc
7946 only fills in DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP (not DT_DEBUG) and GDB only
7947 looks at the first one it sees. */
7948 if (!info->shared
7949 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
7950 return FALSE;
7951
7952 /* The DT_DEBUG entry may be filled in by the dynamic linker and
7953 used by the debugger. */
7954 if (info->executable
7955 && !SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
7956 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
7957 return FALSE;
7958
7959 if (reltext && (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd) || htab->is_vxworks))
7960 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
7961
7962 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
7963 {
7964 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
7965 return FALSE;
7966
7967 /* Clear the DF_TEXTREL flag. It will be set again if we
7968 write out an actual text relocation; we may not, because
7969 at this point we do not know whether e.g. any .eh_frame
7970 absolute relocations have been converted to PC-relative. */
7971 info->flags &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
7972 }
7973
7974 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
7975 return FALSE;
7976
7977 if (htab->is_vxworks)
7978 {
7979 /* VxWorks uses .rela.dyn instead of .rel.dyn. It does not
7980 use any of the DT_MIPS_* tags. */
7981 if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE))
7982 {
7983 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELA, 0))
7984 return FALSE;
7985
7986 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELASZ, 0))
7987 return FALSE;
7988
7989 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELAENT, 0))
7990 return FALSE;
7991 }
7992 if (htab->splt->size > 0)
7993 {
7994 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTREL, 0))
7995 return FALSE;
7996
7997 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_JMPREL, 0))
7998 return FALSE;
7999
8000 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTRELSZ, 0))
8001 return FALSE;
8002 }
8003 }
8004 else
8005 {
8006 if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE))
8007 {
8008 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
8009 return FALSE;
8010
8011 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
8012 return FALSE;
8013
8014 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
8015 return FALSE;
8016 }
8017
8018 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
8019 return FALSE;
8020
8021 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
8022 return FALSE;
8023
8024 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
8025 return FALSE;
8026
8027 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
8028 return FALSE;
8029
8030 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
8031 return FALSE;
8032
8033 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
8034 return FALSE;
8035
8036 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
8037 return FALSE;
8038
8039 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
8040 && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
8041 return FALSE;
8042
8043 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
8044 && (bfd_get_section_by_name
8045 (dynobj, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
8046 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
8047 return FALSE;
8048 }
8049 if (htab->is_vxworks
8050 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
8051 return FALSE;
8052 }
8053
8054 return TRUE;
8055 }
8056 \f
8057 /* REL is a relocation in INPUT_BFD that is being copied to OUTPUT_BFD.
8058 Adjust its R_ADDEND field so that it is correct for the output file.
8059 LOCAL_SYMS and LOCAL_SECTIONS are arrays of INPUT_BFD's local symbols
8060 and sections respectively; both use symbol indexes. */
8061
8062 static void
8063 mips_elf_adjust_addend (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
8064 bfd *input_bfd, Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
8065 asection **local_sections, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
8066 {
8067 unsigned int r_type, r_symndx;
8068 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8069 asection *sec;
8070
8071 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections, FALSE))
8072 {
8073 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
8074 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL
8075 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL16
8076 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
8077 || r_type == R_MIPS_LITERAL)
8078 {
8079 rel->r_addend += _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
8080 rel->r_addend -= _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd);
8081 }
8082
8083 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
8084 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
8085
8086 /* Adjust REL's addend to account for section merging. */
8087 if (!info->relocatable)
8088 {
8089 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
8090 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
8091 }
8092
8093 /* This would normally be done by the rela_normal code in elflink.c. */
8094 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
8095 rel->r_addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
8096 }
8097 }
8098
8099 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section. */
8100
8101 bfd_boolean
8102 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
8103 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
8104 bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
8105 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
8106 asection **local_sections)
8107 {
8108 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
8109 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
8110 bfd_vma addend = 0;
8111 bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
8112 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
8113
8114 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
8115 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
8116 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
8117 {
8118 const char *name;
8119 bfd_vma value = 0;
8120 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8121 bfd_boolean require_jalx;
8122 /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
8123 REL relocation. */
8124 bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
8125 unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
8126 const char *msg;
8127 unsigned long r_symndx;
8128 asection *sec;
8129 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8130 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8131
8132 /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation. */
8133 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type,
8134 NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
8135 && (MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P
8136 (input_bfd, input_section,
8137 rel - relocs)));
8138
8139 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, rel->r_info);
8140 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
8141 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections, FALSE))
8142 {
8143 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
8144 h = NULL;
8145 }
8146 else
8147 {
8148 unsigned long extsymoff;
8149
8150 extsymoff = 0;
8151 if (!elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
8152 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
8153 h = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
8154 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
8155 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
8156 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
8157
8158 sec = NULL;
8159 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
8160 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
8161 sec = h->root.u.def.section;
8162 }
8163
8164 if (sec != NULL && elf_discarded_section (sec))
8165 {
8166 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
8167 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
8168 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
8169 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8170 rel->r_info = 0;
8171 rel->r_addend = 0;
8172 continue;
8173 }
8174
8175 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
8176 {
8177 /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64. In particular, people use
8178 64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
8179 lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
8180 space. Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
8181 usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
8182 stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits. */
8183 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
8184
8185 /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
8186 of the reloc. */
8187 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
8188 rel->r_offset += 4;
8189 }
8190
8191 if (!use_saved_addend_p)
8192 {
8193 /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
8194 we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
8195 relocated. Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
8196 RELA relocation. */
8197 if (mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (input_bfd, input_section,
8198 relocs, rel))
8199 {
8200 rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
8201 addend = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (input_bfd, rel,
8202 howto, contents);
8203 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
8204 || r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16
8205 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
8206 && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
8207 local_sections, FALSE)))
8208 {
8209 if (!mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (input_bfd, rel, relend,
8210 contents, &addend))
8211 {
8212 const char *name;
8213
8214 if (h)
8215 name = h->root.root.string;
8216 else
8217 name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr,
8218 local_syms + r_symndx,
8219 sec);
8220 (*_bfd_error_handler)
8221 (_("%B: Can't find matching LO16 reloc against `%s' for %s at 0x%lx in section `%A'"),
8222 input_bfd, input_section, name, howto->name,
8223 rel->r_offset);
8224 }
8225 }
8226 else
8227 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
8228 }
8229 else
8230 addend = rel->r_addend;
8231 mips_elf_adjust_addend (output_bfd, info, input_bfd,
8232 local_syms, local_sections, rel);
8233 }
8234
8235 if (info->relocatable)
8236 {
8237 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
8238 && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
8239 rel->r_offset -= 4;
8240
8241 if (!rela_relocation_p && rel->r_addend)
8242 {
8243 addend += rel->r_addend;
8244 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
8245 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
8246 addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
8247 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
8248 addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
8249 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
8250 addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
8251 else
8252 addend >>= howto->rightshift;
8253
8254 /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
8255 mask because the place to which we are writing will be
8256 source of the addend in the final link. */
8257 addend &= howto->src_mask;
8258
8259 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
8260 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
8261 ABI. Here, we need to update the addend. It would be
8262 possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
8263 but for endianness. */
8264 {
8265 bfd_vma sign_bits;
8266 bfd_vma low_bits;
8267 bfd_vma high_bits;
8268
8269 if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
8270 #ifdef BFD64
8271 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
8272 #else
8273 sign_bits = -1;
8274 #endif
8275 else
8276 sign_bits = 0;
8277
8278 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
8279 do two separate stores. */
8280 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
8281 {
8282 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
8283 first. */
8284 low_bits = sign_bits;
8285 high_bits = addend;
8286 }
8287 else
8288 {
8289 low_bits = addend;
8290 high_bits = sign_bits;
8291 }
8292 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
8293 contents + rel->r_offset);
8294 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
8295 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
8296 continue;
8297 }
8298
8299 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
8300 input_bfd, input_section,
8301 contents, FALSE))
8302 return FALSE;
8303 }
8304
8305 /* Go on to the next relocation. */
8306 continue;
8307 }
8308
8309 /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
8310 relocations for the same offset. In that case we are
8311 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
8312 for the next. */
8313 if (rel + 1 < relend
8314 && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
8315 && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
8316 use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
8317 else
8318 use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
8319
8320 /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate. */
8321 switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
8322 input_section, info, rel,
8323 addend, howto, local_syms,
8324 local_sections, &value,
8325 &name, &require_jalx,
8326 use_saved_addend_p))
8327 {
8328 case bfd_reloc_continue:
8329 /* There's nothing to do. */
8330 continue;
8331
8332 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
8333 /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
8334 undefined_symbol callback. There's no real point in
8335 trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
8336 just skip ahead to the next relocation. */
8337 continue;
8338
8339 case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
8340 msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
8341 info->callbacks->warning
8342 (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
8343 return FALSE;
8344
8345 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
8346 if (use_saved_addend_p)
8347 /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
8348 a given location. */
8349 ;
8350 else
8351 {
8352 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8353
8354 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8355 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
8356 if (!htab->small_data_overflow_reported
8357 && (howto->type == R_MIPS_GPREL16
8358 || howto->type == R_MIPS_LITERAL))
8359 {
8360 const char *msg =
8361 _("small-data section exceeds 64KB;"
8362 " lower small-data size limit (see option -G)");
8363
8364 htab->small_data_overflow_reported = TRUE;
8365 (*info->callbacks->einfo) ("%P: %s\n", msg);
8366 }
8367 if (! ((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
8368 (info, NULL, name, howto->name, (bfd_vma) 0,
8369 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset)))
8370 return FALSE;
8371 }
8372 break;
8373
8374 case bfd_reloc_ok:
8375 break;
8376
8377 default:
8378 abort ();
8379 break;
8380 }
8381
8382 /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
8383 until we reach the last one. */
8384 if (use_saved_addend_p)
8385 {
8386 addend = value;
8387 continue;
8388 }
8389
8390 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
8391 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
8392 ABI. Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
8393 that calculated the right value. Now, however, we
8394 sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
8395 64-bit value. We are especially generous here in that we
8396 go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
8397 only a 32-bit VMA. */
8398 {
8399 bfd_vma sign_bits;
8400 bfd_vma low_bits;
8401 bfd_vma high_bits;
8402
8403 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
8404 #ifdef BFD64
8405 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
8406 #else
8407 sign_bits = -1;
8408 #endif
8409 else
8410 sign_bits = 0;
8411
8412 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
8413 do two separate stores. */
8414 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
8415 {
8416 /* Undo what we did above. */
8417 rel->r_offset -= 4;
8418 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
8419 first. */
8420 low_bits = sign_bits;
8421 high_bits = value;
8422 }
8423 else
8424 {
8425 low_bits = value;
8426 high_bits = sign_bits;
8427 }
8428 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
8429 contents + rel->r_offset);
8430 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
8431 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
8432 continue;
8433 }
8434
8435 /* Actually perform the relocation. */
8436 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
8437 input_bfd, input_section,
8438 contents, require_jalx))
8439 return FALSE;
8440 }
8441
8442 return TRUE;
8443 }
8444 \f
8445 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
8446 adjust it appropriately now. */
8447
8448 static void
8449 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8450 const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8451 {
8452 /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
8453 these, but we must place them into the right sections. */
8454 static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
8455 "_ftext",
8456 "_etext",
8457 "__dso_displacement",
8458 "__elf_header",
8459 "__program_header_table",
8460 NULL
8461 };
8462
8463 static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
8464 "_fdata",
8465 "_edata",
8466 "_end",
8467 "_fbss",
8468 NULL
8469 };
8470
8471 const char* const *p;
8472 int i;
8473
8474 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
8475 for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
8476 *p;
8477 ++p)
8478 if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
8479 {
8480 /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
8481 IRIX6 linker. */
8482 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8483 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8484
8485 /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections. */
8486 if (i == 0)
8487 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
8488 else
8489 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8490
8491 break;
8492 }
8493 }
8494
8495 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
8496 dynamic sections here. */
8497
8498 bfd_boolean
8499 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
8500 struct bfd_link_info *info,
8501 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8502 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8503 {
8504 bfd *dynobj;
8505 asection *sgot;
8506 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
8507 const char *name;
8508 int idx;
8509 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8510
8511 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8512 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8513
8514 if (h->plt.offset != MINUS_ONE)
8515 {
8516 asection *s;
8517 bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE];
8518
8519 /* This symbol has a stub. Set it up. */
8520
8521 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8522
8523 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
8524 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
8525 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8526
8527 BFD_ASSERT ((htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8528 || (h->dynindx <= 0xffff));
8529
8530 /* Values up to 2^31 - 1 are allowed. Larger values would cause
8531 sign extension at runtime in the stub, resulting in a negative
8532 index value. */
8533 if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fffffff)
8534 return FALSE;
8535
8536 /* Fill the stub. */
8537 idx = 0;
8538 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub + idx);
8539 idx += 4;
8540 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE (output_bfd), stub + idx);
8541 idx += 4;
8542 if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8543 {
8544 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LUI ((h->dynindx >> 16) & 0x7fff),
8545 stub + idx);
8546 idx += 4;
8547 }
8548 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + idx);
8549 idx += 4;
8550
8551 /* If a large stub is not required and sign extension is not a
8552 problem, then use legacy code in the stub. */
8553 if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8554 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_ORI (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
8555 else if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fff)
8556 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16U (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
8557 else
8558 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16S (output_bfd, h->dynindx),
8559 stub + idx);
8560
8561 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= s->size);
8562 memcpy (s->contents + h->plt.offset, stub, htab->function_stub_size);
8563
8564 /* Mark the symbol as undefined. plt.offset != -1 occurs
8565 only for the referenced symbol. */
8566 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8567
8568 /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
8569 to reset the global offset table entry for this external
8570 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object. */
8571 sym->st_value = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
8572 + h->plt.offset);
8573 }
8574
8575 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
8576 || h->forced_local);
8577
8578 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8579 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
8580 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8581 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8582 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8583
8584 /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
8585 the symbols that need them. */
8586 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
8587 && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
8588 {
8589 bfd_vma offset;
8590 bfd_vma value;
8591
8592 value = sym->st_value;
8593 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h, R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
8594 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
8595 }
8596
8597 if (g->next && h->dynindx != -1 && h->type != STT_TLS)
8598 {
8599 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
8600 bfd_vma entry;
8601 bfd_vma offset;
8602
8603 gg = g;
8604
8605 e.abfd = output_bfd;
8606 e.symndx = -1;
8607 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
8608 e.tls_type = 0;
8609
8610 for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
8611 {
8612 if (g->got_entries
8613 && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
8614 &e)))
8615 {
8616 offset = p->gotidx;
8617 if (info->shared
8618 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
8619 && p->d.h != NULL
8620 && p->d.h->root.def_dynamic
8621 && !p->d.h->root.def_regular))
8622 {
8623 /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry. Due to
8624 the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
8625 up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
8626 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
8627 appropriate addend. */
8628 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
8629
8630 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
8631 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
8632 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
8633 else
8634 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
8635 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
8636
8637 entry = 0;
8638 if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
8639 (output_bfd, info, rel,
8640 e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
8641 return FALSE;
8642 }
8643 else
8644 entry = sym->st_value;
8645 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
8646 }
8647 }
8648 }
8649
8650 /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */
8651 name = h->root.root.string;
8652 if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
8653 || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
8654 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8655 else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
8656 || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
8657 {
8658 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8659 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8660 sym->st_value = 1;
8661 }
8662 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
8663 {
8664 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8665 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8666 sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd);
8667 }
8668 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
8669 {
8670 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
8671 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
8672 {
8673 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8674 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8675 sym->st_value = 0;
8676 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8677 }
8678 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
8679 {
8680 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8681 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8682 sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
8683 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8684 }
8685 else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
8686 {
8687 if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
8688 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
8689 else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
8690 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8691 }
8692 }
8693
8694 /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols. */
8695 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
8696 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
8697
8698 if (! info->shared)
8699 {
8700 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
8701 && (strcmp (name, "__rld_map") == 0
8702 || strcmp (name, "__RLD_MAP") == 0))
8703 {
8704 asection *s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map");
8705 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8706 sym->st_value = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
8707 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, s->contents);
8708 if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value == 0)
8709 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
8710 }
8711 else if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
8712 && strcmp (name, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
8713 {
8714 /* IRIX6 does not use a .rld_map section. */
8715 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5
8716 || IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_none)
8717 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map")
8718 != NULL);
8719 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
8720 }
8721 }
8722
8723 /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even. */
8724 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
8725 sym->st_value &= ~1;
8726
8727 return TRUE;
8728 }
8729
8730 /* Likewise, for VxWorks. */
8731
8732 bfd_boolean
8733 _bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
8734 struct bfd_link_info *info,
8735 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8736 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8737 {
8738 bfd *dynobj;
8739 asection *sgot;
8740 struct mips_got_info *g;
8741 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8742
8743 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8744 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8745
8746 if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8747 {
8748 bfd_byte *loc;
8749 bfd_vma plt_address, plt_index, got_address, got_offset, branch_offset;
8750 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8751 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
8752
8753 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8754 BFD_ASSERT (htab->splt != NULL);
8755 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= htab->splt->size);
8756
8757 /* Calculate the address of the .plt entry. */
8758 plt_address = (htab->splt->output_section->vma
8759 + htab->splt->output_offset
8760 + h->plt.offset);
8761
8762 /* Calculate the index of the entry. */
8763 plt_index = ((h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size)
8764 / htab->plt_entry_size);
8765
8766 /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry. */
8767 got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
8768 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
8769 + plt_index * 4);
8770
8771 /* Calculate the offset of the .got.plt entry from
8772 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
8773 got_offset = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, h);
8774
8775 /* Calculate the offset for the branch at the start of the PLT
8776 entry. The branch jumps to the beginning of .plt. */
8777 branch_offset = -(h->plt.offset / 4 + 1) & 0xffff;
8778
8779 /* Fill in the initial value of the .got.plt entry. */
8780 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_address,
8781 htab->sgotplt->contents + plt_index * 4);
8782
8783 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
8784 loc = htab->splt->contents + h->plt.offset;
8785
8786 if (info->shared)
8787 {
8788 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry;
8789 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
8790 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
8791 }
8792 else
8793 {
8794 bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low;
8795
8796 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry;
8797 got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8798 got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
8799
8800 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
8801 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
8802 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_high, loc + 8);
8803 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3] | got_address_low, loc + 12);
8804 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
8805 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
8806 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
8807 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
8808
8809 loc = (htab->srelplt2->contents
8810 + (plt_index * 3 + 2) * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
8811
8812 /* Emit a relocation for the .got.plt entry. */
8813 rel.r_offset = got_address;
8814 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
8815 rel.r_addend = h->plt.offset;
8816 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8817
8818 /* Emit a relocation for the lui of %hi(<.got.plt slot>). */
8819 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8820 rel.r_offset = plt_address + 8;
8821 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8822 rel.r_addend = got_offset;
8823 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8824
8825 /* Emit a relocation for the addiu of %lo(<.got.plt slot>). */
8826 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8827 rel.r_offset += 4;
8828 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8829 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8830 }
8831
8832 /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry. */
8833 loc = htab->srelplt->contents + plt_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8834 rel.r_offset = got_address;
8835 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT);
8836 rel.r_addend = 0;
8837 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8838
8839 if (!h->def_regular)
8840 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8841 }
8842
8843 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1 || h->forced_local);
8844
8845 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8846 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
8847 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8848 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8849 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8850
8851 /* See if this symbol has an entry in the GOT. */
8852 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
8853 && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
8854 {
8855 bfd_vma offset;
8856 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
8857 bfd_byte *loc;
8858 asection *s;
8859
8860 /* Install the symbol value in the GOT. */
8861 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h,
8862 R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
8863 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, sym->st_value, sgot->contents + offset);
8864
8865 /* Add a dynamic relocation for it. */
8866 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
8867 loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
8868 outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
8869 + sgot->output_offset
8870 + offset);
8871 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_32);
8872 outrel.r_addend = 0;
8873 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (dynobj, &outrel, loc);
8874 }
8875
8876 /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed. */
8877 if (h->needs_copy)
8878 {
8879 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8880
8881 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8882
8883 rel.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
8884 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
8885 + h->root.u.def.value);
8886 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY);
8887 rel.r_addend = 0;
8888 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel,
8889 htab->srelbss->contents
8890 + (htab->srelbss->reloc_count
8891 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
8892 ++htab->srelbss->reloc_count;
8893 }
8894
8895 /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even. */
8896 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
8897 sym->st_value &= ~1;
8898
8899 return TRUE;
8900 }
8901
8902 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks executable and finalize the
8903 contents of .rela.plt.unloaded. */
8904
8905 static void
8906 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8907 {
8908 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
8909 bfd_byte *loc;
8910 bfd_vma got_value, got_value_high, got_value_low, plt_address;
8911 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
8912 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8913
8914 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8915 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry;
8916
8917 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
8918 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
8919 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
8920 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
8921
8922 got_value_high = ((got_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8923 got_value_low = got_value & 0xffff;
8924
8925 /* Calculate the address of the PLT header. */
8926 plt_address = htab->splt->output_section->vma + htab->splt->output_offset;
8927
8928 /* Install the PLT header. */
8929 loc = htab->splt->contents;
8930 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_value_high, loc);
8931 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_value_low, loc + 4);
8932 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 8);
8933 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
8934 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
8935 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
8936
8937 /* Output the relocation for the lui of %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
8938 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
8939 rela.r_offset = plt_address;
8940 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8941 rela.r_addend = 0;
8942 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
8943 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8944
8945 /* Output the relocation for the following addiu of
8946 %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
8947 rela.r_offset += 4;
8948 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8949 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
8950 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8951
8952 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
8953 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
8954 in which symbols were output. */
8955 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
8956 {
8957 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8958
8959 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8960 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
8961 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8962 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8963
8964 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8965 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8966 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8967 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8968
8969 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8970 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8971 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8972 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8973 }
8974 }
8975
8976 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks shared library. */
8977
8978 static void
8979 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8980 {
8981 unsigned int i;
8982 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8983
8984 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8985
8986 /* We just need to copy the entry byte-by-byte. */
8987 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry); i++)
8988 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[i],
8989 htab->splt->contents + i * 4);
8990 }
8991
8992 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
8993
8994 bfd_boolean
8995 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
8996 struct bfd_link_info *info)
8997 {
8998 bfd *dynobj;
8999 asection *sdyn;
9000 asection *sgot;
9001 struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
9002 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9003
9004 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9005 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9006
9007 sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9008
9009 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
9010 if (sgot == NULL)
9011 gg = g = NULL;
9012 else
9013 {
9014 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
9015 gg = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
9016 BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
9017 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, output_bfd);
9018 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
9019 }
9020
9021 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
9022 {
9023 bfd_byte *b;
9024 int dyn_to_skip = 0, dyn_skipped = 0;
9025
9026 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
9027 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
9028
9029 for (b = sdyn->contents;
9030 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
9031 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
9032 {
9033 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9034 const char *name;
9035 size_t elemsize;
9036 asection *s;
9037 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
9038
9039 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
9040 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
9041
9042 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
9043 swap_out_p = TRUE;
9044
9045 switch (dyn.d_tag)
9046 {
9047 case DT_RELENT:
9048 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
9049 break;
9050
9051 case DT_RELAENT:
9052 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
9053 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj);
9054 break;
9055
9056 case DT_STRSZ:
9057 /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ. */
9058 dyn.d_un.d_val =
9059 _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
9060 break;
9061
9062 case DT_PLTGOT:
9063 name = ".got";
9064 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9065 {
9066 /* _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ is defined to be the beginning
9067 of the ".got" section in DYNOBJ. */
9068 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, name);
9069 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9070 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9071 }
9072 else
9073 {
9074 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
9075 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9076 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
9077 }
9078 break;
9079
9080 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
9081 dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
9082 break;
9083
9084 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
9085 dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
9086 break;
9087
9088 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
9089 {
9090 time_t t;
9091 time (&t);
9092 dyn.d_un.d_val = t;
9093 }
9094 break;
9095
9096 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
9097 /* XXX FIXME: */
9098 swap_out_p = FALSE;
9099 break;
9100
9101 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
9102 /* XXX FIXME: */
9103 swap_out_p = FALSE;
9104 break;
9105
9106 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
9107 s = output_bfd->sections;
9108 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9109 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
9110 break;
9111
9112 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
9113 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
9114 break;
9115
9116 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
9117 /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
9118 entry of the first external symbol that is not
9119 referenced within the same object. */
9120 dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
9121 break;
9122
9123 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
9124 if (gg->global_gotsym)
9125 {
9126 dyn.d_un.d_val = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
9127 break;
9128 }
9129 /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
9130 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
9131 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, so we just fall through. */
9132
9133 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
9134 name = ".dynsym";
9135 elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
9136 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
9137 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9138
9139 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size / elemsize;
9140 break;
9141
9142 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
9143 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
9144 break;
9145
9146 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
9147 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value;
9148 break;
9149
9150 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
9151 s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
9152 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
9153 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
9154 break;
9155
9156 case DT_RELASZ:
9157 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
9158 /* The count does not include the JUMP_SLOT relocations. */
9159 if (htab->srelplt)
9160 dyn.d_un.d_val -= htab->srelplt->size;
9161 break;
9162
9163 case DT_PLTREL:
9164 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
9165 dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_RELA;
9166 break;
9167
9168 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9169 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
9170 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->srelplt->size;
9171 break;
9172
9173 case DT_JMPREL:
9174 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
9175 dyn.d_un.d_val = (htab->srelplt->output_section->vma
9176 + htab->srelplt->output_offset);
9177 break;
9178
9179 case DT_TEXTREL:
9180 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, delete
9181 the dynamic tag. */
9182 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
9183 {
9184 dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
9185 swap_out_p = FALSE;
9186 }
9187 break;
9188
9189 case DT_FLAGS:
9190 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, clear
9191 DF_TEXTREL from DT_FLAGS. */
9192 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
9193 dyn.d_un.d_val &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
9194 else
9195 swap_out_p = FALSE;
9196 break;
9197
9198 default:
9199 swap_out_p = FALSE;
9200 if (htab->is_vxworks
9201 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9202 swap_out_p = TRUE;
9203 break;
9204 }
9205
9206 if (swap_out_p || dyn_skipped)
9207 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
9208 (dynobj, &dyn, b - dyn_skipped);
9209
9210 if (dyn_to_skip)
9211 {
9212 dyn_skipped += dyn_to_skip;
9213 dyn_to_skip = 0;
9214 }
9215 }
9216
9217 /* Wipe out any trailing entries if we shifted down a dynamic tag. */
9218 if (dyn_skipped > 0)
9219 memset (b - dyn_skipped, 0, dyn_skipped);
9220 }
9221
9222 if (sgot != NULL && sgot->size > 0
9223 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sgot->output_section))
9224 {
9225 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9226 {
9227 /* The first entry of the global offset table points to the
9228 ".dynamic" section. The second is initialized by the
9229 loader and contains the shared library identifier.
9230 The third is also initialized by the loader and points
9231 to the lazy resolution stub. */
9232 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd,
9233 sdyn->output_offset + sdyn->output_section->vma,
9234 sgot->contents);
9235 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
9236 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
9237 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
9238 sgot->contents
9239 + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
9240 }
9241 else
9242 {
9243 /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
9244 runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
9245 This isn't the case of IRIX rld. */
9246 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, sgot->contents);
9247 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK (output_bfd),
9248 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
9249 }
9250
9251 elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
9252 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
9253 }
9254
9255 /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots. */
9256 if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
9257 {
9258 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
9259 bfd_vma addend = 0;
9260
9261 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
9262 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
9263
9264 for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
9265 {
9266 bfd_vma index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno
9267 + g->next->tls_gotno;
9268
9269 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
9270 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
9271 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK (output_bfd),
9272 sgot->contents
9273 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
9274
9275 if (! info->shared)
9276 continue;
9277
9278 while (index < g->assigned_gotno)
9279 {
9280 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
9281 = index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
9282 if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
9283 (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
9284 bfd_abs_section_ptr,
9285 0, &addend, sgot)))
9286 return FALSE;
9287 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
9288 }
9289 }
9290 }
9291
9292 /* The generation of dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots
9293 adds more dynamic relocations. We cannot count them until
9294 here. */
9295
9296 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
9297 {
9298 bfd_byte *b;
9299 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
9300
9301 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
9302
9303 for (b = sdyn->contents;
9304 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
9305 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
9306 {
9307 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9308 asection *s;
9309
9310 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
9311 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
9312
9313 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
9314 swap_out_p = TRUE;
9315
9316 switch (dyn.d_tag)
9317 {
9318 case DT_RELSZ:
9319 /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
9320 decided not to make. This is for the n64 irix rld,
9321 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
9322 are trailing null entries. */
9323 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
9324 dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
9325 * (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
9326 ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
9327 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
9328 /* Adjust the section size too. Tools like the prelinker
9329 can reasonably expect the values to the same. */
9330 elf_section_data (s->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_size
9331 = dyn.d_un.d_val;
9332 break;
9333
9334 default:
9335 swap_out_p = FALSE;
9336 break;
9337 }
9338
9339 if (swap_out_p)
9340 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
9341 (dynobj, &dyn, b);
9342 }
9343 }
9344
9345 {
9346 asection *s;
9347 Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
9348
9349 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
9350 {
9351 /* Write .compact_rel section out. */
9352 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
9353 if (s != NULL)
9354 {
9355 cpt.id1 = 1;
9356 cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
9357 cpt.id2 = 2;
9358 cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
9359 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
9360 cpt.reserved0 = 0;
9361 cpt.reserved1 = 0;
9362 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
9363 ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
9364 s->contents));
9365
9366 /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text. */
9367 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
9368 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
9369 if (s != NULL)
9370 {
9371 file_ptr dummy_offset;
9372
9373 BFD_ASSERT (s->size >= htab->function_stub_size);
9374 dummy_offset = s->size - htab->function_stub_size;
9375 memset (s->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
9376 htab->function_stub_size);
9377 }
9378 }
9379 }
9380
9381 /* The psABI says that the dynamic relocations must be sorted in
9382 increasing order of r_symndx. The VxWorks EABI doesn't require
9383 this, and because the code below handles REL rather than RELA
9384 relocations, using it for VxWorks would be outright harmful. */
9385 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
9386 {
9387 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
9388 if (s != NULL
9389 && s->size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
9390 {
9391 reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
9392
9393 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
9394 qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
9395 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel),
9396 sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
9397 else
9398 qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
9399 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel),
9400 sort_dynamic_relocs);
9401 }
9402 }
9403 }
9404
9405 if (htab->is_vxworks && htab->splt->size > 0)
9406 {
9407 if (info->shared)
9408 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (output_bfd, info);
9409 else
9410 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info);
9411 }
9412 return TRUE;
9413 }
9414
9415
9416 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags. */
9417
9418 static void
9419 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
9420 {
9421 flagword val;
9422
9423 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
9424 {
9425 default:
9426 case bfd_mach_mips3000:
9427 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
9428 break;
9429
9430 case bfd_mach_mips3900:
9431 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
9432 break;
9433
9434 case bfd_mach_mips6000:
9435 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
9436 break;
9437
9438 case bfd_mach_mips4000:
9439 case bfd_mach_mips4300:
9440 case bfd_mach_mips4400:
9441 case bfd_mach_mips4600:
9442 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
9443 break;
9444
9445 case bfd_mach_mips4010:
9446 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
9447 break;
9448
9449 case bfd_mach_mips4100:
9450 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
9451 break;
9452
9453 case bfd_mach_mips4111:
9454 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
9455 break;
9456
9457 case bfd_mach_mips4120:
9458 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
9459 break;
9460
9461 case bfd_mach_mips4650:
9462 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
9463 break;
9464
9465 case bfd_mach_mips5400:
9466 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
9467 break;
9468
9469 case bfd_mach_mips5500:
9470 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
9471 break;
9472
9473 case bfd_mach_mips9000:
9474 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_9000;
9475 break;
9476
9477 case bfd_mach_mips5000:
9478 case bfd_mach_mips7000:
9479 case bfd_mach_mips8000:
9480 case bfd_mach_mips10000:
9481 case bfd_mach_mips12000:
9482 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
9483 break;
9484
9485 case bfd_mach_mips5:
9486 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
9487 break;
9488
9489 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e:
9490 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS2E;
9491 break;
9492
9493 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f:
9494 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS2F;
9495 break;
9496
9497 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
9498 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
9499 break;
9500
9501 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon:
9502 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON;
9503 break;
9504
9505 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
9506 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
9507 break;
9508
9509 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
9510 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
9511 break;
9512
9513 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
9514 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
9515 break;
9516
9517 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
9518 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
9519 break;
9520 }
9521 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
9522 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
9523
9524 }
9525
9526
9527 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
9528 file. This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
9529 number. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
9530
9531 void
9532 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
9533 bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9534 {
9535 unsigned int i;
9536 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
9537 const char *name;
9538 asection *sec;
9539
9540 /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
9541 is nonzero. This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
9542 a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH. */
9543 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
9544 mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
9545
9546 /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
9547 info for each special section. */
9548 for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
9549 i < elf_numsections (abfd);
9550 i++, hdrpp++)
9551 {
9552 switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
9553 {
9554 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
9555 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
9556 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
9557 if (sec != NULL)
9558 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9559 break;
9560
9561 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
9562 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9563 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9564 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
9565 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."));
9566 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
9567 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9568 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9569 break;
9570
9571 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
9572 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9573 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9574 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
9575 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"));
9576 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9577 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
9578 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9579 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9580 break;
9581
9582 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
9583 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
9584 if (sec != NULL)
9585 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9586 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
9587 if (sec != NULL)
9588 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9589 break;
9590
9591 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
9592 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9593 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9594 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
9595 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events"))
9596 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9597 name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
9598 else
9599 {
9600 BFD_ASSERT (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"));
9601 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9602 (name
9603 + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
9604 }
9605 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9606 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9607 break;
9608
9609 }
9610 }
9611 }
9612 \f
9613 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
9614 segments. */
9615
9616 int
9617 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
9618 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9619 {
9620 asection *s;
9621 int ret = 0;
9622
9623 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment. */
9624 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
9625 if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
9626 ++ret;
9627
9628 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment. */
9629 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
9630 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9631 MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
9632 ++ret;
9633
9634 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment. */
9635 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
9636 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
9637 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
9638 ++ret;
9639
9640 /* Allocate a PT_NULL header in dynamic objects. See
9641 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map for details. */
9642 if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9643 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
9644 ++ret;
9645
9646 return ret;
9647 }
9648
9649 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable. */
9650
9651 bfd_boolean
9652 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
9653 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9654 {
9655 asection *s;
9656 struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
9657 bfd_size_type amt;
9658
9659 /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
9660 segment. */
9661 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
9662 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
9663 {
9664 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
9665 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
9666 break;
9667 if (m == NULL)
9668 {
9669 amt = sizeof *m;
9670 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9671 if (m == NULL)
9672 return FALSE;
9673
9674 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
9675 m->count = 1;
9676 m->sections[0] = s;
9677
9678 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
9679 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9680 while (*pm != NULL
9681 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
9682 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
9683 pm = &(*pm)->next;
9684
9685 m->next = *pm;
9686 *pm = m;
9687 }
9688 }
9689
9690 /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
9691 .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC. However, we do have to insert a
9692 PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
9693 table. */
9694 if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
9695 /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
9696 for this section, so don't create another. I'm not sure this
9697 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
9698 now. */
9699 && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
9700 {
9701 for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
9702 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
9703 break;
9704
9705 if (s)
9706 {
9707 struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
9708
9709 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9710 while (*pm != NULL
9711 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
9712 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
9713 pm = &(*pm)->next;
9714
9715 if (*pm == NULL || (*pm)->p_type != PT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
9716 {
9717 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
9718 options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9719 options_segment->next = *pm;
9720 options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
9721 options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
9722 options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
9723 options_segment->count = 1;
9724 options_segment->sections[0] = s;
9725 *pm = options_segment;
9726 }
9727 }
9728 }
9729 else
9730 {
9731 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
9732 {
9733 /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
9734 for the RTPROC header. FIXME: Rewrite without section names. */
9735 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
9736 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
9737 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
9738 {
9739 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
9740 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
9741 break;
9742 if (m == NULL)
9743 {
9744 amt = sizeof *m;
9745 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9746 if (m == NULL)
9747 return FALSE;
9748
9749 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
9750
9751 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
9752 if (s == NULL)
9753 {
9754 m->count = 0;
9755 m->p_flags = 0;
9756 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
9757 }
9758 else
9759 {
9760 m->count = 1;
9761 m->sections[0] = s;
9762 }
9763
9764 /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment. */
9765 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9766 while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
9767 pm = &(*pm)->next;
9768 if (*pm != NULL)
9769 pm = &(*pm)->next;
9770
9771 m->next = *pm;
9772 *pm = m;
9773 }
9774 }
9775 }
9776 /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
9777 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
9778 between. */
9779 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL;
9780 pm = &(*pm)->next)
9781 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
9782 break;
9783 m = *pm;
9784 if (m != NULL && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
9785 {
9786 /* For a normal mips executable the permissions for the PT_DYNAMIC
9787 segment are read, write and execute. We do that here since
9788 the code in elf.c sets only the read permission. This matters
9789 sometimes for the dynamic linker. */
9790 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
9791 {
9792 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_W | PF_X;
9793 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
9794 }
9795 }
9796 /* GNU/Linux binaries do not need the extended PT_DYNAMIC section.
9797 glibc's dynamic linker has traditionally derived the number of
9798 tags from the p_filesz field, and sometimes allocates stack
9799 arrays of that size. An overly-big PT_DYNAMIC segment can
9800 be actively harmful in such cases. Making PT_DYNAMIC contain
9801 other sections can also make life hard for the prelinker,
9802 which might move one of the other sections to a different
9803 PT_LOAD segment. */
9804 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9805 && m != NULL
9806 && m->count == 1
9807 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
9808 {
9809 static const char *sec_names[] =
9810 {
9811 ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
9812 };
9813 bfd_vma low, high;
9814 unsigned int i, c;
9815 struct elf_segment_map *n;
9816
9817 low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
9818 high = 0;
9819 for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
9820 {
9821 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
9822 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
9823 {
9824 bfd_size_type sz;
9825
9826 if (low > s->vma)
9827 low = s->vma;
9828 sz = s->size;
9829 if (high < s->vma + sz)
9830 high = s->vma + sz;
9831 }
9832 }
9833
9834 c = 0;
9835 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9836 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
9837 && s->vma >= low
9838 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
9839 ++c;
9840
9841 amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
9842 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9843 if (n == NULL)
9844 return FALSE;
9845 *n = *m;
9846 n->count = c;
9847
9848 i = 0;
9849 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9850 {
9851 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
9852 && s->vma >= low
9853 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
9854 {
9855 n->sections[i] = s;
9856 ++i;
9857 }
9858 }
9859
9860 *pm = n;
9861 }
9862 }
9863
9864 /* Allocate a spare program header in dynamic objects so that tools
9865 like the prelinker can add an extra PT_LOAD entry.
9866
9867 If the prelinker needs to make room for a new PT_LOAD entry, its
9868 standard procedure is to move the first (read-only) sections into
9869 the new (writable) segment. However, the MIPS ABI requires
9870 .dynamic to be in a read-only segment, and the section will often
9871 start within sizeof (ElfNN_Phdr) bytes of the last program header.
9872
9873 Although the prelinker could in principle move .dynamic to a
9874 writable segment, it seems better to allocate a spare program
9875 header instead, and avoid the need to move any sections.
9876 There is a long tradition of allocating spare dynamic tags,
9877 so allocating a spare program header seems like a natural
9878 extension.
9879
9880 If INFO is NULL, we may be copying an already prelinked binary
9881 with objcopy or strip, so do not add this header. */
9882 if (info != NULL
9883 && !SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9884 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
9885 {
9886 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL; pm = &(*pm)->next)
9887 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_NULL)
9888 break;
9889 if (*pm == NULL)
9890 {
9891 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*m));
9892 if (m == NULL)
9893 return FALSE;
9894
9895 m->p_type = PT_NULL;
9896 *pm = m;
9897 }
9898 }
9899
9900 return TRUE;
9901 }
9902 \f
9903 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
9904 relocation. */
9905
9906 asection *
9907 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
9908 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9909 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
9910 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9911 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9912 {
9913 /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special? */
9914
9915 if (h != NULL)
9916 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
9917 {
9918 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
9919 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
9920 return NULL;
9921 }
9922
9923 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
9924 }
9925
9926 /* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed. */
9927
9928 bfd_boolean
9929 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9930 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9931 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9932 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9933 {
9934 #if 0
9935 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9936 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
9937 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
9938 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
9939 unsigned long r_symndx;
9940 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9941
9942 if (info->relocatable)
9943 return TRUE;
9944
9945 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
9946 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
9947 local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
9948
9949 relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
9950 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
9951 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info))
9952 {
9953 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
9954 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
9955 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
9956 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
9957 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
9958 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
9959 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
9960 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
9961 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
9962 /* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort
9963 of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries,
9964 so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time. */
9965 break;
9966
9967 default:
9968 break;
9969 }
9970 #endif
9971
9972 return TRUE;
9973 }
9974 \f
9975 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
9976 hiding the old indirect symbol. Process additional relocation
9977 information. Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
9978 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us. */
9979
9980 void
9981 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9982 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
9983 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
9984 {
9985 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
9986
9987 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
9988
9989 if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9990 return;
9991
9992 dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
9993 indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
9994 dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
9995 if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
9996 dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
9997 if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
9998 dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
9999
10000 if (dirmips->tls_type == 0)
10001 dirmips->tls_type = indmips->tls_type;
10002 }
10003
10004 void
10005 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
10006 struct elf_link_hash_entry *entry,
10007 bfd_boolean force_local)
10008 {
10009 bfd *dynobj;
10010 asection *got;
10011 struct mips_got_info *g;
10012 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10013 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10014
10015 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
10016 if (h->forced_local)
10017 return;
10018 h->forced_local = force_local;
10019
10020 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10021 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10022 if (dynobj != NULL && force_local && h->root.type != STT_TLS
10023 && (got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, TRUE)) != NULL
10024 && (g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info) != NULL)
10025 {
10026 if (g->next)
10027 {
10028 struct mips_got_entry e;
10029 struct mips_got_info *gg = g;
10030
10031 /* Since we're turning what used to be a global symbol into a
10032 local one, bump up the number of local entries of each GOT
10033 that had an entry for it. This will automatically decrease
10034 the number of global entries, since global_gotno is actually
10035 the upper limit of global entries. */
10036 e.abfd = dynobj;
10037 e.symndx = -1;
10038 e.d.h = h;
10039 e.tls_type = 0;
10040
10041 for (g = g->next; g != gg; g = g->next)
10042 if (htab_find (g->got_entries, &e))
10043 {
10044 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
10045 g->local_gotno++;
10046 g->global_gotno--;
10047 }
10048
10049 /* If this was a global symbol forced into the primary GOT, we
10050 no longer need an entry for it. We can't release the entry
10051 at this point, but we must at least stop counting it as one
10052 of the symbols that required a forced got entry. */
10053 if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
10054 {
10055 BFD_ASSERT (gg->assigned_gotno > 0);
10056 gg->assigned_gotno--;
10057 }
10058 }
10059 else if (h->root.got.offset == 1)
10060 {
10061 /* check_relocs didn't know that this symbol would be
10062 forced-local, so add an extra local got entry. */
10063 g->local_gotno++;
10064 if (htab->computed_got_sizes)
10065 {
10066 /* We'll have treated this symbol as global rather
10067 than local. */
10068 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
10069 g->global_gotno--;
10070 }
10071 }
10072 else if (htab->is_vxworks && h->root.needs_plt)
10073 {
10074 /* check_relocs didn't know that this symbol would be
10075 forced-local, so add an extra local got entry. */
10076 g->local_gotno++;
10077 if (htab->computed_got_sizes)
10078 /* The symbol is only used in call relocations, so we'll
10079 have assumed it only needs a .got.plt entry. Increase
10080 the size of .got accordingly. */
10081 got->size += MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj);
10082 }
10083 }
10084
10085 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->root, force_local);
10086 }
10087 \f
10088 #define PDR_SIZE 32
10089
10090 bfd_boolean
10091 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
10092 struct bfd_link_info *info)
10093 {
10094 asection *o;
10095 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
10096 unsigned char *tdata;
10097 size_t i, skip;
10098
10099 o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
10100 if (! o)
10101 return FALSE;
10102 if (o->size == 0)
10103 return FALSE;
10104 if (o->size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
10105 return FALSE;
10106 if (o->output_section != NULL
10107 && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
10108 return FALSE;
10109
10110 tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->size / PDR_SIZE);
10111 if (! tdata)
10112 return FALSE;
10113
10114 cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
10115 info->keep_memory);
10116 if (!cookie->rels)
10117 {
10118 free (tdata);
10119 return FALSE;
10120 }
10121
10122 cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
10123 cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
10124
10125 for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
10126 {
10127 if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
10128 {
10129 tdata[i] = 1;
10130 skip ++;
10131 }
10132 }
10133
10134 if (skip != 0)
10135 {
10136 mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
10137 o->size -= skip * PDR_SIZE;
10138 ret = TRUE;
10139 }
10140 else
10141 free (tdata);
10142
10143 if (! info->keep_memory)
10144 free (cookie->rels);
10145
10146 return ret;
10147 }
10148
10149 bfd_boolean
10150 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
10151 {
10152 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
10153 return TRUE;
10154 return FALSE;
10155 }
10156
10157 bfd_boolean
10158 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd,
10159 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10160 asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
10161 {
10162 bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
10163 int i;
10164
10165 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
10166 return FALSE;
10167
10168 if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
10169 return FALSE;
10170
10171 to = contents;
10172 end = contents + sec->size;
10173 for (from = contents, i = 0;
10174 from < end;
10175 from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
10176 {
10177 if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
10178 continue;
10179 if (to != from)
10180 memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
10181 to += PDR_SIZE;
10182 }
10183 bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
10184 sec->output_offset, sec->size);
10185 return TRUE;
10186 }
10187 \f
10188 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
10189 handle the ECOFF debugging information. */
10190
10191 struct mips_elf_find_line
10192 {
10193 struct ecoff_debug_info d;
10194 struct ecoff_find_line i;
10195 };
10196
10197 bfd_boolean
10198 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
10199 asymbol **symbols, bfd_vma offset,
10200 const char **filename_ptr,
10201 const char **functionname_ptr,
10202 unsigned int *line_ptr)
10203 {
10204 asection *msec;
10205
10206 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
10207 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
10208 line_ptr))
10209 return TRUE;
10210
10211 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
10212 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
10213 line_ptr, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0,
10214 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
10215 return TRUE;
10216
10217 msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
10218 if (msec != NULL)
10219 {
10220 flagword origflags;
10221 struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
10222 const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
10223 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
10224
10225 /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
10226 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field. We force it back on here
10227 if appropriate (which it normally will be). */
10228 origflags = msec->flags;
10229 if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
10230 msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10231
10232 fi = elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
10233 if (fi == NULL)
10234 {
10235 bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
10236 char *fraw_src;
10237 char *fraw_end;
10238 struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
10239 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
10240
10241 fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
10242 if (fi == NULL)
10243 {
10244 msec->flags = origflags;
10245 return FALSE;
10246 }
10247
10248 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
10249 {
10250 msec->flags = origflags;
10251 return FALSE;
10252 }
10253
10254 /* Swap in the FDR information. */
10255 amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
10256 fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
10257 if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
10258 {
10259 msec->flags = origflags;
10260 return FALSE;
10261 }
10262 external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
10263 fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
10264 fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
10265 fraw_end = (fraw_src
10266 + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
10267 for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
10268 (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
10269
10270 elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
10271
10272 /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
10273 find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
10274 objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
10275 rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
10276 wasted is unimportant. Still, it would probably be a
10277 good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away. */
10278 }
10279
10280 if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
10281 &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
10282 line_ptr))
10283 {
10284 msec->flags = origflags;
10285 return TRUE;
10286 }
10287
10288 msec->flags = origflags;
10289 }
10290
10291 /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine. */
10292
10293 return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
10294 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
10295 line_ptr);
10296 }
10297
10298 bfd_boolean
10299 _bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
10300 const char **filename_ptr,
10301 const char **functionname_ptr,
10302 unsigned int *line_ptr)
10303 {
10304 bfd_boolean found;
10305 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
10306 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
10307 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
10308 return found;
10309 }
10310
10311 \f
10312 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
10313 remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
10314 GP value in the section_processing routine. */
10315
10316 bfd_boolean
10317 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
10318 const void *location,
10319 file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
10320 {
10321 if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (section->name))
10322 {
10323 bfd_byte *c;
10324
10325 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
10326 {
10327 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
10328 section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
10329 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
10330 return FALSE;
10331 }
10332 c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
10333 if (c == NULL)
10334 {
10335 c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, section->size);
10336 if (c == NULL)
10337 return FALSE;
10338 mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
10339 }
10340
10341 memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
10342 }
10343
10344 return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
10345 count);
10346 }
10347
10348 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
10349 MIPS relocations need to be handled specially. Sigh. */
10350
10351 bfd_byte *
10352 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
10353 (bfd *abfd,
10354 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
10355 struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
10356 bfd_byte *data,
10357 bfd_boolean relocatable,
10358 asymbol **symbols)
10359 {
10360 /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
10361 bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
10362 asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
10363 bfd_size_type sz;
10364
10365 long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
10366 arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
10367 long reloc_count;
10368
10369 if (reloc_size < 0)
10370 goto error_return;
10371
10372 reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
10373 if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
10374 goto error_return;
10375
10376 /* read in the section */
10377 sz = input_section->rawsize ? input_section->rawsize : input_section->size;
10378 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0, sz))
10379 goto error_return;
10380
10381 reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
10382 input_section,
10383 reloc_vector,
10384 symbols);
10385 if (reloc_count < 0)
10386 goto error_return;
10387
10388 if (reloc_count > 0)
10389 {
10390 arelent **parent;
10391 /* for mips */
10392 int gp_found;
10393 bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678; /* initialize just to shut gcc up */
10394
10395 {
10396 struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
10397 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
10398 /* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats. */
10399 if (abfd && input_bfd
10400 && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
10401 lh = 0;
10402 else
10403 {
10404 h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
10405 lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
10406 }
10407 lookup:
10408 if (lh)
10409 {
10410 switch (lh->type)
10411 {
10412 case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
10413 case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
10414 case bfd_link_hash_common:
10415 gp_found = 0;
10416 break;
10417 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
10418 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
10419 gp_found = 1;
10420 gp = lh->u.def.value;
10421 break;
10422 case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
10423 case bfd_link_hash_warning:
10424 lh = lh->u.i.link;
10425 /* @@FIXME ignoring warning for now */
10426 goto lookup;
10427 case bfd_link_hash_new:
10428 default:
10429 abort ();
10430 }
10431 }
10432 else
10433 gp_found = 0;
10434 }
10435 /* end mips */
10436 for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
10437 {
10438 char *error_message = NULL;
10439 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
10440
10441 /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
10442 knowing the gp of the output bfd. */
10443 asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
10444
10445 /* If we've managed to find the gp and have a special
10446 function for the relocation then go ahead, else default
10447 to the generic handling. */
10448 if (gp_found
10449 && (*parent)->howto->special_function
10450 == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
10451 r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
10452 input_section, relocatable,
10453 data, gp);
10454 else
10455 r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data,
10456 input_section,
10457 relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
10458 &error_message);
10459
10460 if (relocatable)
10461 {
10462 asection *os = input_section->output_section;
10463
10464 /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
10465 os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
10466 os->reloc_count++;
10467 }
10468
10469 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
10470 {
10471 switch (r)
10472 {
10473 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
10474 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
10475 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
10476 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address, TRUE)))
10477 goto error_return;
10478 break;
10479 case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
10480 BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
10481 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
10482 (link_info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
10483 (*parent)->address)))
10484 goto error_return;
10485 break;
10486 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
10487 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
10488 (link_info, NULL,
10489 bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
10490 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
10491 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address)))
10492 goto error_return;
10493 break;
10494 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
10495 default:
10496 abort ();
10497 break;
10498 }
10499
10500 }
10501 }
10502 }
10503 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
10504 free (reloc_vector);
10505 return data;
10506
10507 error_return:
10508 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
10509 free (reloc_vector);
10510 return NULL;
10511 }
10512 \f
10513 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
10514
10515 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10516 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10517 {
10518 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
10519 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
10520
10521 ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
10522 if (ret == NULL)
10523 return NULL;
10524
10525 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
10526 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
10527 sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry)))
10528 {
10529 free (ret);
10530 return NULL;
10531 }
10532
10533 #if 0
10534 /* We no longer use this. */
10535 for (i = 0; i < SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES; i++)
10536 ret->dynsym_sec_strindex[i] = (bfd_size_type) -1;
10537 #endif
10538 ret->procedure_count = 0;
10539 ret->compact_rel_size = 0;
10540 ret->use_rld_obj_head = FALSE;
10541 ret->rld_value = 0;
10542 ret->mips16_stubs_seen = FALSE;
10543 ret->computed_got_sizes = FALSE;
10544 ret->is_vxworks = FALSE;
10545 ret->small_data_overflow_reported = FALSE;
10546 ret->srelbss = NULL;
10547 ret->sdynbss = NULL;
10548 ret->srelplt = NULL;
10549 ret->srelplt2 = NULL;
10550 ret->sgotplt = NULL;
10551 ret->splt = NULL;
10552 ret->plt_header_size = 0;
10553 ret->plt_entry_size = 0;
10554 ret->function_stub_size = 0;
10555
10556 return &ret->root.root;
10557 }
10558
10559 /* Likewise, but indicate that the target is VxWorks. */
10560
10561 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10562 _bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10563 {
10564 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10565
10566 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10567 if (ret)
10568 {
10569 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10570
10571 htab = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ret;
10572 htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10573 }
10574 return ret;
10575 }
10576 \f
10577 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
10578 the .mdebug sections. We need to merge all instances of these
10579 sections together, not write them all out sequentially. */
10580
10581 bfd_boolean
10582 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
10583 {
10584 asection *o;
10585 struct bfd_link_order *p;
10586 asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
10587 asection *rtproc_sec;
10588 Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
10589 struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
10590 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10591 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap = bed->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
10592 HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
10593 void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
10594 asection *s;
10595 EXTR esym;
10596 unsigned int i;
10597 bfd_size_type amt;
10598 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10599
10600 static const char * const secname[] =
10601 {
10602 ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
10603 ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
10604 };
10605 static const int sc[] =
10606 {
10607 scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
10608 scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
10609 };
10610
10611 /* We'd carefully arranged the dynamic symbol indices, and then the
10612 generic size_dynamic_sections renumbered them out from under us.
10613 Rather than trying somehow to prevent the renumbering, just do
10614 the sort again. */
10615 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10616 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
10617 {
10618 bfd *dynobj;
10619 asection *got;
10620 struct mips_got_info *g;
10621 bfd_size_type dynsecsymcount;
10622
10623 /* When we resort, we must tell mips_elf_sort_hash_table what
10624 the lowest index it may use is. That's the number of section
10625 symbols we're going to add. The generic ELF linker only
10626 adds these symbols when building a shared object. Note that
10627 we count the sections after (possibly) removing the .options
10628 section above. */
10629
10630 dynsecsymcount = count_section_dynsyms (abfd, info);
10631 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, dynsecsymcount + 1))
10632 return FALSE;
10633
10634 /* Make sure we didn't grow the global .got region. */
10635 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10636 got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
10637 g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info;
10638
10639 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
10640 BFD_ASSERT ((elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
10641 - g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
10642 <= g->global_gotno);
10643 }
10644
10645 /* Get a value for the GP register. */
10646 if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
10647 {
10648 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
10649
10650 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
10651 if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
10652 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
10653 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
10654 + h->u.def.section->output_offset);
10655 else if (htab->is_vxworks
10656 && (h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash,
10657 "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_",
10658 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE))
10659 && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
10660 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
10661 + h->u.def.section->output_offset
10662 + h->u.def.value);
10663 else if (info->relocatable)
10664 {
10665 bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
10666
10667 /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset. */
10668 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
10669 if (o->vma < lo
10670 && (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
10671 lo = o->vma;
10672
10673 /* And calculate GP relative to that. */
10674 elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (info);
10675 }
10676 else
10677 {
10678 /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
10679 involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
10680 callback to warn that GP is not defined. */
10681 }
10682 }
10683
10684 /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
10685 information. */
10686 reginfo_sec = NULL;
10687 mdebug_sec = NULL;
10688 gptab_data_sec = NULL;
10689 gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
10690 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
10691 {
10692 if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
10693 {
10694 memset (&reginfo, 0, sizeof reginfo);
10695
10696 /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
10697 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
10698 the information together. */
10699 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10700 {
10701 asection *input_section;
10702 bfd *input_bfd;
10703 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
10704 Elf32_RegInfo sub;
10705
10706 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10707 {
10708 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10709 continue;
10710 abort ();
10711 }
10712
10713 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10714 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10715
10716 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
10717 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
10718 return FALSE;
10719
10720 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
10721
10722 reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
10723 reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
10724 reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
10725 reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
10726 reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
10727
10728 /* ri_gp_value is set by the function
10729 mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is
10730 finally written out. */
10731
10732 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10733 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
10734 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10735 }
10736
10737 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
10738 BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
10739
10740 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10741 matters, but someday it might). */
10742 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10743
10744 reginfo_sec = o;
10745 }
10746
10747 if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
10748 {
10749 struct extsym_info einfo;
10750 bfd_vma last;
10751
10752 /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
10753 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
10754 the information together. */
10755 symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
10756 /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be? */
10757 symhdr->vstamp = 0;
10758 symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
10759 symhdr->cbLine = 0;
10760 symhdr->idnMax = 0;
10761 symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
10762 symhdr->isymMax = 0;
10763 symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
10764 symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
10765 symhdr->issMax = 0;
10766 symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
10767 symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
10768 symhdr->crfd = 0;
10769 symhdr->iextMax = 0;
10770
10771 /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
10772 debug_info structure. */
10773 debug.line = NULL;
10774 debug.external_dnr = NULL;
10775 debug.external_pdr = NULL;
10776 debug.external_sym = NULL;
10777 debug.external_opt = NULL;
10778 debug.external_aux = NULL;
10779 debug.ss = NULL;
10780 debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
10781 debug.external_fdr = NULL;
10782 debug.external_rfd = NULL;
10783 debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
10784
10785 mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
10786 if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
10787 return FALSE;
10788
10789 esym.jmptbl = 0;
10790 esym.cobol_main = 0;
10791 esym.weakext = 0;
10792 esym.reserved = 0;
10793 esym.ifd = ifdNil;
10794 esym.asym.iss = issNil;
10795 esym.asym.st = stLocal;
10796 esym.asym.reserved = 0;
10797 esym.asym.index = indexNil;
10798 last = 0;
10799 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
10800 {
10801 esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
10802 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
10803 if (s != NULL)
10804 {
10805 esym.asym.value = s->vma;
10806 last = s->vma + s->size;
10807 }
10808 else
10809 esym.asym.value = last;
10810 if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
10811 secname[i], &esym))
10812 return FALSE;
10813 }
10814
10815 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10816 {
10817 asection *input_section;
10818 bfd *input_bfd;
10819 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
10820 struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
10821 char *eraw_src;
10822 char *eraw_end;
10823
10824 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10825 {
10826 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10827 continue;
10828 abort ();
10829 }
10830
10831 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10832 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10833
10834 if (bfd_get_flavour (input_bfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
10835 || (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
10836 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap) == NULL)
10837 {
10838 /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
10839 doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
10840 want to deal with it. */
10841 continue;
10842 }
10843
10844 input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
10845 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
10846
10847 BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->size);
10848
10849 /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
10850 read in the debugging information and set up an
10851 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now. */
10852 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
10853 &input_debug))
10854 return FALSE;
10855
10856 if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
10857 (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
10858 &input_debug, input_swap, info)))
10859 return FALSE;
10860
10861 /* Loop through the external symbols. For each one with
10862 interesting information, try to find the symbol in
10863 the linker global hash table and save the information
10864 for the output external symbols. */
10865 eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
10866 eraw_end = (eraw_src
10867 + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
10868 * input_swap->external_ext_size));
10869 for (;
10870 eraw_src < eraw_end;
10871 eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
10872 {
10873 EXTR ext;
10874 const char *name;
10875 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10876
10877 (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
10878 if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
10879 || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
10880 || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
10881 continue;
10882
10883 name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
10884 h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
10885 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
10886 if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
10887 continue;
10888
10889 if (ext.ifd != -1)
10890 {
10891 BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
10892 < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
10893 ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
10894 }
10895
10896 h->esym = ext;
10897 }
10898
10899 /* Free up the information we just read. */
10900 free (input_debug.line);
10901 free (input_debug.external_dnr);
10902 free (input_debug.external_pdr);
10903 free (input_debug.external_sym);
10904 free (input_debug.external_opt);
10905 free (input_debug.external_aux);
10906 free (input_debug.ss);
10907 free (input_debug.ssext);
10908 free (input_debug.external_fdr);
10909 free (input_debug.external_rfd);
10910 free (input_debug.external_ext);
10911
10912 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10913 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
10914 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10915 }
10916
10917 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && info->shared)
10918 {
10919 /* Create .rtproc section. */
10920 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
10921 if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
10922 {
10923 flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
10924 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
10925
10926 rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
10927 ".rtproc",
10928 flags);
10929 if (rtproc_sec == NULL
10930 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
10931 return FALSE;
10932 }
10933
10934 if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
10935 info, rtproc_sec,
10936 &debug))
10937 return FALSE;
10938 }
10939
10940 /* Build the external symbol information. */
10941 einfo.abfd = abfd;
10942 einfo.info = info;
10943 einfo.debug = &debug;
10944 einfo.swap = swap;
10945 einfo.failed = FALSE;
10946 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
10947 mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
10948 if (einfo.failed)
10949 return FALSE;
10950
10951 /* Set the size of the .mdebug section. */
10952 o->size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
10953
10954 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10955 matters, but someday it might). */
10956 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10957
10958 mdebug_sec = o;
10959 }
10960
10961 if (CONST_STRNEQ (o->name, ".gptab."))
10962 {
10963 const char *subname;
10964 unsigned int c;
10965 Elf32_gptab *tab;
10966 Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
10967 unsigned int j;
10968
10969 /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
10970 information describing how the small data area would
10971 change depending upon the -G switch. These sections
10972 not used in executables files. */
10973 if (! info->relocatable)
10974 {
10975 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10976 {
10977 asection *input_section;
10978
10979 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10980 {
10981 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10982 continue;
10983 abort ();
10984 }
10985
10986 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10987
10988 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10989 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
10990 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10991 }
10992
10993 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
10994 currently matters, but someday it might). */
10995 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10996
10997 /* Really remove the section. */
10998 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, o);
10999 --abfd->section_count;
11000
11001 continue;
11002 }
11003
11004 /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
11005 uninitialized data. */
11006 if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
11007 gptab_data_sec = o;
11008 else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
11009 gptab_bss_sec = o;
11010 else
11011 {
11012 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11013 (_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"),
11014 bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name);
11015 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
11016 return FALSE;
11017 }
11018
11019 /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
11020 .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
11021 .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss. It is possible that there is
11022 no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
11023 case we must change the name of the output section. */
11024 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
11025 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
11026 {
11027 if (o == gptab_data_sec)
11028 o->name = ".gptab.data";
11029 else
11030 o->name = ".gptab.bss";
11031 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
11032 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
11033 }
11034
11035 /* Set up the first entry. */
11036 c = 1;
11037 amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
11038 tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
11039 if (tab == NULL)
11040 return FALSE;
11041 tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
11042 tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
11043
11044 /* Combine the input sections. */
11045 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
11046 {
11047 asection *input_section;
11048 bfd *input_bfd;
11049 bfd_size_type size;
11050 unsigned long last;
11051 bfd_size_type gpentry;
11052
11053 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
11054 {
11055 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
11056 continue;
11057 abort ();
11058 }
11059
11060 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
11061 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
11062
11063 /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
11064 by one. We know that the input gptab entries are
11065 sorted by ascending -G value. */
11066 size = input_section->size;
11067 last = 0;
11068 for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
11069 gpentry < size;
11070 gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
11071 {
11072 Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
11073 Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
11074 unsigned long val;
11075 unsigned long add;
11076 bfd_boolean exact;
11077 unsigned int look;
11078
11079 if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
11080 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
11081 sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
11082 {
11083 free (tab);
11084 return FALSE;
11085 }
11086
11087 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
11088 &int_gptab);
11089 val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
11090 add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
11091
11092 exact = FALSE;
11093 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
11094 {
11095 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
11096 tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
11097
11098 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
11099 exact = TRUE;
11100 }
11101
11102 if (! exact)
11103 {
11104 Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
11105 unsigned int max;
11106
11107 /* We need a new table entry. */
11108 amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
11109 new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
11110 if (new_tab == NULL)
11111 {
11112 free (tab);
11113 return FALSE;
11114 }
11115 tab = new_tab;
11116 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
11117 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
11118
11119 /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
11120 value, since that will be implied by this new
11121 value. */
11122 max = 0;
11123 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
11124 {
11125 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
11126 && (max == 0
11127 || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
11128 > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
11129 max = look;
11130 }
11131 if (max != 0)
11132 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
11133 tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
11134
11135 ++c;
11136 }
11137
11138 last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
11139 }
11140
11141 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
11142 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
11143 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
11144 }
11145
11146 /* The table must be sorted by -G value. */
11147 if (c > 2)
11148 qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
11149
11150 /* Swap out the table. */
11151 amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
11152 ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
11153 if (ext_tab == NULL)
11154 {
11155 free (tab);
11156 return FALSE;
11157 }
11158
11159 for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
11160 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
11161 free (tab);
11162
11163 o->size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
11164 o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
11165
11166 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
11167 matters, but someday it might). */
11168 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
11169 }
11170 }
11171
11172 /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */
11173 if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
11174 return FALSE;
11175
11176 /* Now write out the computed sections. */
11177
11178 if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
11179 {
11180 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
11181
11182 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, &reginfo, &ext);
11183 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
11184 return FALSE;
11185 }
11186
11187 if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
11188 {
11189 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
11190 if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
11191 swap, info,
11192 mdebug_sec->filepos))
11193 return FALSE;
11194
11195 bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
11196 }
11197
11198 if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
11199 {
11200 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
11201 gptab_data_sec->contents,
11202 0, gptab_data_sec->size))
11203 return FALSE;
11204 }
11205
11206 if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
11207 {
11208 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
11209 gptab_bss_sec->contents,
11210 0, gptab_bss_sec->size))
11211 return FALSE;
11212 }
11213
11214 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
11215 {
11216 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
11217 if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
11218 {
11219 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
11220 rtproc_sec->contents,
11221 0, rtproc_sec->size))
11222 return FALSE;
11223 }
11224 }
11225
11226 return TRUE;
11227 }
11228 \f
11229 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE. */
11230
11231 struct mips_mach_extension {
11232 unsigned long extension, base;
11233 };
11234
11235
11236 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another. The entries
11237 are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last. */
11238
11239 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] = {
11240 /* MIPS64r2 extensions. */
11241 { bfd_mach_mips_octeon, bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2 },
11242
11243 /* MIPS64 extensions. */
11244 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
11245 { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
11246
11247 /* MIPS V extensions. */
11248 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
11249
11250 /* R10000 extensions. */
11251 { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
11252
11253 /* R5000 extensions. Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
11254 vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff. It seems
11255 better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
11256 many libraries will just use the core ISA. Perhaps we could add
11257 some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem. */
11258 { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
11259 { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
11260
11261 /* MIPS IV extensions. */
11262 { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
11263 { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
11264 { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
11265 { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
11266 { bfd_mach_mips9000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
11267
11268 /* VR4100 extensions. */
11269 { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
11270 { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
11271
11272 /* MIPS III extensions. */
11273 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
11274 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
11275 { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
11276 { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
11277 { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
11278 { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
11279 { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
11280 { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
11281 { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
11282
11283 /* MIPS32 extensions. */
11284 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
11285
11286 /* MIPS II extensions. */
11287 { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
11288 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
11289
11290 /* MIPS I extensions. */
11291 { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
11292 { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
11293 };
11294
11295
11296 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE. */
11297
11298 static bfd_boolean
11299 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
11300 {
11301 size_t i;
11302
11303 if (extension == base)
11304 return TRUE;
11305
11306 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32
11307 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64, extension))
11308 return TRUE;
11309
11310 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2
11311 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
11312 return TRUE;
11313
11314 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
11315 if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
11316 {
11317 extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
11318 if (extension == base)
11319 return TRUE;
11320 }
11321
11322 return FALSE;
11323 }
11324
11325
11326 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary. */
11327
11328 static bfd_boolean
11329 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
11330 {
11331 return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
11332 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
11333 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
11334 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
11335 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
11336 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
11337 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2);
11338 }
11339
11340
11341 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Raise an error if
11342 there are conflicting attributes. */
11343 static bfd_boolean
11344 mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
11345 {
11346 obj_attribute *in_attr;
11347 obj_attribute *out_attr;
11348
11349 if (!elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i)
11350 {
11351 /* This is the first object. Copy the attributes. */
11352 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
11353
11354 /* Use the Tag_null value to indicate the attributes have been
11355 initialized. */
11356 elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i = 1;
11357
11358 return TRUE;
11359 }
11360
11361 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP attributes and merge
11362 non-conflicting ones. */
11363 in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
11364 out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
11365 if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11366 {
11367 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].type = 1;
11368 if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
11369 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
11370 else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
11371 ;
11372 else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i > 4)
11373 _bfd_error_handler
11374 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"), ibfd,
11375 in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
11376 else if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i > 4)
11377 _bfd_error_handler
11378 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"), obfd,
11379 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
11380 else
11381 switch (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11382 {
11383 case 1:
11384 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11385 {
11386 case 2:
11387 _bfd_error_handler
11388 (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mdouble-float"),
11389 obfd, ibfd);
11390 break;
11391
11392 case 3:
11393 _bfd_error_handler
11394 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11395 obfd, ibfd);
11396 break;
11397
11398 case 4:
11399 _bfd_error_handler
11400 (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mips32r2 -mfp64"),
11401 obfd, ibfd);
11402 break;
11403
11404 default:
11405 abort ();
11406 }
11407 break;
11408
11409 case 2:
11410 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11411 {
11412 case 1:
11413 _bfd_error_handler
11414 (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mdouble-float"),
11415 ibfd, obfd);
11416 break;
11417
11418 case 3:
11419 _bfd_error_handler
11420 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11421 obfd, ibfd);
11422 break;
11423
11424 case 4:
11425 _bfd_error_handler
11426 (_("Warning: %B uses -mdouble-float, %B uses -mips32r2 -mfp64"),
11427 obfd, ibfd);
11428 break;
11429
11430 default:
11431 abort ();
11432 }
11433 break;
11434
11435 case 3:
11436 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11437 {
11438 case 1:
11439 case 2:
11440 case 4:
11441 _bfd_error_handler
11442 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11443 ibfd, obfd);
11444 break;
11445
11446 default:
11447 abort ();
11448 }
11449 break;
11450
11451 case 4:
11452 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11453 {
11454 case 1:
11455 _bfd_error_handler
11456 (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mips32r2 -mfp64"),
11457 ibfd, obfd);
11458 break;
11459
11460 case 2:
11461 _bfd_error_handler
11462 (_("Warning: %B uses -mdouble-float, %B uses -mips32r2 -mfp64"),
11463 ibfd, obfd);
11464 break;
11465
11466 case 3:
11467 _bfd_error_handler
11468 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11469 obfd, ibfd);
11470 break;
11471
11472 default:
11473 abort ();
11474 }
11475 break;
11476
11477 default:
11478 abort ();
11479 }
11480 }
11481
11482 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
11483 _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
11484
11485 return TRUE;
11486 }
11487
11488 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
11489 object file when linking. */
11490
11491 bfd_boolean
11492 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
11493 {
11494 flagword old_flags;
11495 flagword new_flags;
11496 bfd_boolean ok;
11497 bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
11498 asection *sec;
11499
11500 /* Check if we have the same endianess */
11501 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
11502 {
11503 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11504 (_("%B: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
11505 ibfd);
11506 return FALSE;
11507 }
11508
11509 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
11510 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11511 return TRUE;
11512
11513 if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
11514 {
11515 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11516 (_("%B: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
11517 ibfd);
11518 return FALSE;
11519 }
11520
11521 if (!mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd))
11522 return FALSE;
11523
11524 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
11525 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11526 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
11527
11528 if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
11529 {
11530 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
11531 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
11532 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11533 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
11534
11535 if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
11536 && (bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default
11537 || mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd),
11538 bfd_get_mach (ibfd))))
11539 {
11540 if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
11541 bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
11542 return FALSE;
11543 }
11544
11545 return TRUE;
11546 }
11547
11548 /* Check flag compatibility. */
11549
11550 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11551 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11552
11553 /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set. It
11554 doesn't seem to matter. */
11555 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
11556 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
11557
11558 /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects. Again, we should
11559 just be able to ignore this. */
11560 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
11561 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
11562
11563 /* Don't care about the PIC flags from dynamic objects; they are
11564 PIC by design. */
11565 if ((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0
11566 && (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
11567 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11568
11569 if (new_flags == old_flags)
11570 return TRUE;
11571
11572 /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections.
11573 If not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it cannot
11574 actually cause any incompatibility. */
11575 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
11576 {
11577 /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
11578 which are automatically generated by gas. */
11579 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
11580 && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
11581 && (sec->size != 0
11582 || (strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
11583 && strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
11584 && strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))))
11585 {
11586 null_input_bfd = FALSE;
11587 break;
11588 }
11589 }
11590 if (null_input_bfd)
11591 return TRUE;
11592
11593 ok = TRUE;
11594
11595 if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
11596 != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
11597 {
11598 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11599 (_("%B: warning: linking PIC files with non-PIC files"),
11600 ibfd);
11601 ok = TRUE;
11602 }
11603
11604 if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
11605 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
11606 if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
11607 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
11608
11609 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11610 old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11611
11612 /* Compare the ISAs. */
11613 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
11614 {
11615 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11616 (_("%B: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
11617 ibfd);
11618 ok = FALSE;
11619 }
11620 else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
11621 {
11622 /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's. */
11623 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
11624 {
11625 /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD. Also copy
11626 the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
11627 OBFD as a 32-bit binary. */
11628 bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
11629 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
11630 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
11631 |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11632
11633 /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
11634 and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit. */
11635 if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
11636 && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
11637 && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
11638 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
11639 }
11640 else
11641 {
11642 /* The ISAs aren't compatible. */
11643 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11644 (_("%B: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
11645 ibfd,
11646 bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
11647 bfd_printable_name (obfd));
11648 ok = FALSE;
11649 }
11650 }
11651
11652 new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11653 old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11654
11655 /* Compare ABIs. The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI. But, it
11656 does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI. */
11657 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
11658 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11659 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
11660 {
11661 /* Only error if both are set (to different values). */
11662 if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
11663 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11664 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
11665 {
11666 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11667 (_("%B: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
11668 ibfd,
11669 elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
11670 elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
11671 ok = FALSE;
11672 }
11673 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
11674 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
11675 }
11676
11677 /* For now, allow arbitrary mixing of ASEs (retain the union). */
11678 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
11679 {
11680 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11681
11682 new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11683 old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11684 }
11685
11686 /* Warn about any other mismatches */
11687 if (new_flags != old_flags)
11688 {
11689 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11690 (_("%B: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules (0x%lx)"),
11691 ibfd, (unsigned long) new_flags,
11692 (unsigned long) old_flags);
11693 ok = FALSE;
11694 }
11695
11696 if (! ok)
11697 {
11698 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11699 return FALSE;
11700 }
11701
11702 return TRUE;
11703 }
11704
11705 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC. */
11706
11707 bfd_boolean
11708 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
11709 {
11710 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
11711 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
11712
11713 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
11714 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
11715 return TRUE;
11716 }
11717
11718 char *
11719 _bfd_mips_elf_get_target_dtag (bfd_vma dtag)
11720 {
11721 switch (dtag)
11722 {
11723 default: return "";
11724 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
11725 return "MIPS_RLD_VERSION";
11726 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
11727 return "MIPS_TIME_STAMP";
11728 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
11729 return "MIPS_ICHECKSUM";
11730 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
11731 return "MIPS_IVERSION";
11732 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
11733 return "MIPS_FLAGS";
11734 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
11735 return "MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS";
11736 case DT_MIPS_MSYM:
11737 return "MIPS_MSYM";
11738 case DT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
11739 return "MIPS_CONFLICT";
11740 case DT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
11741 return "MIPS_LIBLIST";
11742 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
11743 return "MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO";
11744 case DT_MIPS_CONFLICTNO:
11745 return "MIPS_CONFLICTNO";
11746 case DT_MIPS_LIBLISTNO:
11747 return "MIPS_LIBLISTNO";
11748 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
11749 return "MIPS_SYMTABNO";
11750 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
11751 return "MIPS_UNREFEXTNO";
11752 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
11753 return "MIPS_GOTSYM";
11754 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
11755 return "MIPS_HIPAGENO";
11756 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
11757 return "MIPS_RLD_MAP";
11758 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASS:
11759 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASS";
11760 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASS_NO:
11761 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASS_NO";
11762 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE:
11763 return "MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE";
11764 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE_NO:
11765 return "MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE_NO";
11766 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_RELOC:
11767 return "MIPS_DELTA_RELOC";
11768 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_RELOC_NO:
11769 return "MIPS_DELTA_RELOC_NO";
11770 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_SYM:
11771 return "MIPS_DELTA_SYM";
11772 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_SYM_NO:
11773 return "MIPS_DELTA_SYM_NO";
11774 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM:
11775 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM";
11776 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM_NO:
11777 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM_NO";
11778 case DT_MIPS_CXX_FLAGS:
11779 return "MIPS_CXX_FLAGS";
11780 case DT_MIPS_PIXIE_INIT:
11781 return "MIPS_PIXIE_INIT";
11782 case DT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
11783 return "MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB";
11784 case DT_MIPS_LOCALPAGE_GOTIDX:
11785 return "MIPS_LOCALPAGE_GOTIDX";
11786 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTIDX:
11787 return "MIPS_LOCAL_GOTIDX";
11788 case DT_MIPS_HIDDEN_GOTIDX:
11789 return "MIPS_HIDDEN_GOTIDX";
11790 case DT_MIPS_PROTECTED_GOTIDX:
11791 return "MIPS_PROTECTED_GOT_IDX";
11792 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
11793 return "MIPS_OPTIONS";
11794 case DT_MIPS_INTERFACE:
11795 return "MIPS_INTERFACE";
11796 case DT_MIPS_DYNSTR_ALIGN:
11797 return "DT_MIPS_DYNSTR_ALIGN";
11798 case DT_MIPS_INTERFACE_SIZE:
11799 return "DT_MIPS_INTERFACE_SIZE";
11800 case DT_MIPS_RLD_TEXT_RESOLVE_ADDR:
11801 return "DT_MIPS_RLD_TEXT_RESOLVE_ADDR";
11802 case DT_MIPS_PERF_SUFFIX:
11803 return "DT_MIPS_PERF_SUFFIX";
11804 case DT_MIPS_COMPACT_SIZE:
11805 return "DT_MIPS_COMPACT_SIZE";
11806 case DT_MIPS_GP_VALUE:
11807 return "DT_MIPS_GP_VALUE";
11808 case DT_MIPS_AUX_DYNAMIC:
11809 return "DT_MIPS_AUX_DYNAMIC";
11810 }
11811 }
11812
11813 bfd_boolean
11814 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
11815 {
11816 FILE *file = ptr;
11817
11818 BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
11819
11820 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
11821 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
11822
11823 /* xgettext:c-format */
11824 fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
11825
11826 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
11827 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
11828 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
11829 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
11830 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
11831 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
11832 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
11833 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
11834 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
11835 fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
11836 else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
11837 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
11838 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
11839 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
11840 else
11841 fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
11842
11843 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
11844 fprintf (file, " [mips1]");
11845 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
11846 fprintf (file, " [mips2]");
11847 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
11848 fprintf (file, " [mips3]");
11849 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
11850 fprintf (file, " [mips4]");
11851 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
11852 fprintf (file, " [mips5]");
11853 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
11854 fprintf (file, " [mips32]");
11855 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
11856 fprintf (file, " [mips64]");
11857 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
11858 fprintf (file, " [mips32r2]");
11859 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
11860 fprintf (file, " [mips64r2]");
11861 else
11862 fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
11863
11864 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
11865 fprintf (file, " [mdmx]");
11866
11867 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
11868 fprintf (file, " [mips16]");
11869
11870 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
11871 fprintf (file, " [32bitmode]");
11872 else
11873 fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
11874
11875 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER)
11876 fprintf (file, " [noreorder]");
11877
11878 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC)
11879 fprintf (file, " [PIC]");
11880
11881 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_CPIC)
11882 fprintf (file, " [CPIC]");
11883
11884 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_XGOT)
11885 fprintf (file, " [XGOT]");
11886
11887 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_UCODE)
11888 fprintf (file, " [UCODE]");
11889
11890 fputc ('\n', file);
11891
11892 return TRUE;
11893 }
11894
11895 const struct bfd_elf_special_section _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[] =
11896 {
11897 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit4"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11898 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit8"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11899 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".mdebug"), 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
11900 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11901 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11902 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ucode"), 0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
11903 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
11904 };
11905
11906 /* Merge non visibility st_other attributes. Ensure that the
11907 STO_OPTIONAL flag is copied into h->other, even if this is not a
11908 definiton of the symbol. */
11909 void
11910 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
11911 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
11912 bfd_boolean definition,
11913 bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11914 {
11915 if ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) != 0)
11916 {
11917 unsigned char other;
11918
11919 other = (definition ? isym->st_other : h->other);
11920 other &= ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1);
11921 h->other = other | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other);
11922 }
11923
11924 if (!definition
11925 && ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (isym->st_other))
11926 h->other |= STO_OPTIONAL;
11927 }
11928
11929 /* Decide whether an undefined symbol is special and can be ignored.
11930 This is the case for OPTIONAL symbols on IRIX. */
11931 bfd_boolean
11932 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
11933 {
11934 return ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->other) ? TRUE : FALSE;
11935 }
11936
11937 bfd_boolean
11938 _bfd_mips_elf_common_definition (Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
11939 {
11940 return (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
11941 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON
11942 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON);
11943 }
This page took 0.281257 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.